elf.c revision 1.6 1 1.1 skrll /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2 1.1 skrll
3 1.6 christos Copyright (C) 1993-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 1.1 skrll
5 1.1 skrll This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 1.1 skrll
7 1.1 skrll This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 1.1 skrll it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 1.1 skrll the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 1.1 skrll (at your option) any later version.
11 1.1 skrll
12 1.1 skrll This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 1.1 skrll but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 1.1 skrll MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 1.1 skrll GNU General Public License for more details.
16 1.1 skrll
17 1.1 skrll You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 1.1 skrll along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 1.1 skrll Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 1.1 skrll MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21 1.1 skrll
22 1.1 skrll
23 1.1 skrll /*
24 1.1 skrll SECTION
25 1.1 skrll ELF backends
26 1.1 skrll
27 1.1 skrll BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 1.1 skrll Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 1.1 skrll (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30 1.1 skrll
31 1.1 skrll Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 1.1 skrll to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 1.1 skrll haven't bothered yet. */
34 1.1 skrll
35 1.1 skrll /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 1.1 skrll #define _SYSCALL32
37 1.1 skrll #include "sysdep.h"
38 1.1 skrll #include "bfd.h"
39 1.1 skrll #include "bfdlink.h"
40 1.1 skrll #include "libbfd.h"
41 1.1 skrll #define ARCH_SIZE 0
42 1.1 skrll #include "elf-bfd.h"
43 1.1 skrll #include "libiberty.h"
44 1.1 skrll #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 1.6 christos #include "elf-linux-psinfo.h"
46 1.1 skrll
47 1.3 christos #ifdef CORE_HEADER
48 1.3 christos #include CORE_HEADER
49 1.3 christos #endif
50 1.3 christos
51 1.1 skrll static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
56 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
57 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset);
58 1.1 skrll
59 1.1 skrll /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 1.1 skrll currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 1.1 skrll need to move into elfcode.h. */
62 1.1 skrll
63 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
64 1.1 skrll
65 1.1 skrll void
66 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
67 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
68 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
69 1.1 skrll {
70 1.1 skrll dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
71 1.1 skrll dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
72 1.1 skrll dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
73 1.1 skrll dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
74 1.1 skrll dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
75 1.1 skrll dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
76 1.1 skrll dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
77 1.1 skrll }
78 1.1 skrll
79 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
80 1.1 skrll
81 1.1 skrll void
82 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
83 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
84 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
85 1.1 skrll {
86 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
87 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
88 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
89 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
90 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
91 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
92 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
93 1.1 skrll }
94 1.1 skrll
95 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
96 1.1 skrll
97 1.1 skrll void
98 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
99 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
100 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
101 1.1 skrll {
102 1.1 skrll dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
103 1.1 skrll dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
104 1.1 skrll }
105 1.1 skrll
106 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
107 1.1 skrll
108 1.1 skrll void
109 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
110 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
111 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
112 1.1 skrll {
113 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
114 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
115 1.1 skrll }
116 1.1 skrll
117 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
118 1.1 skrll
119 1.1 skrll void
120 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
121 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
122 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
123 1.1 skrll {
124 1.1 skrll dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
125 1.1 skrll dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
126 1.1 skrll dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
127 1.1 skrll dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
128 1.1 skrll dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
129 1.1 skrll }
130 1.1 skrll
131 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
132 1.1 skrll
133 1.1 skrll void
134 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
135 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
136 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
137 1.1 skrll {
138 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
139 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
140 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
141 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
142 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
143 1.1 skrll }
144 1.1 skrll
145 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
146 1.1 skrll
147 1.1 skrll void
148 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
149 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
150 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
151 1.1 skrll {
152 1.1 skrll dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
153 1.1 skrll dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
154 1.1 skrll dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
155 1.1 skrll dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
156 1.1 skrll dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
157 1.1 skrll }
158 1.1 skrll
159 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
160 1.1 skrll
161 1.1 skrll void
162 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
163 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
164 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
165 1.1 skrll {
166 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
167 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
168 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
169 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
170 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
171 1.1 skrll }
172 1.1 skrll
173 1.1 skrll /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
174 1.1 skrll
175 1.1 skrll void
176 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
177 1.1 skrll const Elf_External_Versym *src,
178 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
179 1.1 skrll {
180 1.1 skrll dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
181 1.1 skrll }
182 1.1 skrll
183 1.1 skrll /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
184 1.1 skrll
185 1.1 skrll void
186 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
187 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
188 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Versym *dst)
189 1.1 skrll {
190 1.1 skrll H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
191 1.1 skrll }
192 1.1 skrll
193 1.1 skrll /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 1.1 skrll cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
195 1.1 skrll
196 1.1 skrll unsigned long
197 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
198 1.1 skrll {
199 1.1 skrll const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
200 1.1 skrll unsigned long h = 0;
201 1.1 skrll unsigned long g;
202 1.1 skrll int ch;
203 1.1 skrll
204 1.1 skrll while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
205 1.1 skrll {
206 1.1 skrll h = (h << 4) + ch;
207 1.1 skrll if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
208 1.1 skrll {
209 1.1 skrll h ^= g >> 24;
210 1.1 skrll /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 1.1 skrll this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
212 1.1 skrll h ^= g;
213 1.1 skrll }
214 1.1 skrll }
215 1.1 skrll return h & 0xffffffff;
216 1.1 skrll }
217 1.1 skrll
218 1.1 skrll /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 1.1 skrll cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
220 1.1 skrll
221 1.1 skrll unsigned long
222 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
223 1.1 skrll {
224 1.1 skrll const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
225 1.1 skrll unsigned long h = 5381;
226 1.1 skrll unsigned char ch;
227 1.1 skrll
228 1.1 skrll while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
229 1.1 skrll h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
230 1.1 skrll return h & 0xffffffff;
231 1.1 skrll }
232 1.1 skrll
233 1.1 skrll /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 1.1 skrll the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
235 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
236 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
237 1.1 skrll size_t object_size,
238 1.3 christos enum elf_target_id object_id)
239 1.1 skrll {
240 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
241 1.1 skrll abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
242 1.1 skrll if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
243 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
244 1.1 skrll
245 1.1 skrll elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
246 1.6 christos if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
247 1.6 christos {
248 1.6 christos struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
249 1.6 christos if (o == NULL)
250 1.6 christos return FALSE;
251 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
252 1.6 christos elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
253 1.6 christos }
254 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
255 1.1 skrll }
256 1.1 skrll
257 1.1 skrll
258 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
259 1.3 christos bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
260 1.1 skrll {
261 1.3 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
262 1.1 skrll return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
263 1.3 christos bed->target_id);
264 1.1 skrll }
265 1.1 skrll
266 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
267 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
268 1.1 skrll {
269 1.1 skrll /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 1.6 christos if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
271 1.6 christos return FALSE;
272 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
273 1.6 christos return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
274 1.1 skrll }
275 1.1 skrll
276 1.3 christos static char *
277 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
278 1.1 skrll {
279 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
280 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
281 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset;
282 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
283 1.1 skrll
284 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
285 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp == 0
286 1.1 skrll || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
287 1.1 skrll || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
288 1.1 skrll return NULL;
289 1.1 skrll
290 1.1 skrll shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
291 1.1 skrll if (shstrtab == NULL)
292 1.1 skrll {
293 1.1 skrll /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 1.1 skrll offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
295 1.1 skrll shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
296 1.1 skrll
297 1.1 skrll /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 1.1 skrll in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 1.1 skrll if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
300 1.6 christos || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
301 1.6 christos || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
302 1.1 skrll shstrtab = NULL;
303 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
304 1.1 skrll {
305 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
306 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
307 1.6 christos bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
308 1.1 skrll shstrtab = NULL;
309 1.1 skrll /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
310 1.1 skrll trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
311 1.1 skrll the string table over and over. */
312 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
313 1.1 skrll }
314 1.1 skrll else
315 1.1 skrll shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
316 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
317 1.1 skrll }
318 1.1 skrll return (char *) shstrtab;
319 1.1 skrll }
320 1.1 skrll
321 1.1 skrll char *
322 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
323 1.1 skrll unsigned int shindex,
324 1.1 skrll unsigned int strindex)
325 1.1 skrll {
326 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
327 1.1 skrll
328 1.1 skrll if (strindex == 0)
329 1.1 skrll return "";
330 1.1 skrll
331 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
332 1.1 skrll return NULL;
333 1.1 skrll
334 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
335 1.1 skrll
336 1.6 christos if (hdr->contents == NULL)
337 1.6 christos {
338 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
339 1.6 christos {
340 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
341 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: attempt to load strings from a non-string section (number %d)"),
342 1.6 christos abfd, shindex);
343 1.6 christos return NULL;
344 1.6 christos }
345 1.6 christos
346 1.6 christos if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
347 1.6 christos return NULL;
348 1.6 christos }
349 1.1 skrll
350 1.1 skrll if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
351 1.1 skrll {
352 1.1 skrll unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
353 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
354 1.1 skrll (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
355 1.1 skrll abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
356 1.1 skrll (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
357 1.1 skrll ? ".shstrtab"
358 1.1 skrll : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
359 1.3 christos return NULL;
360 1.1 skrll }
361 1.1 skrll
362 1.1 skrll return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
363 1.1 skrll }
364 1.1 skrll
365 1.1 skrll /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
366 1.1 skrll SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
367 1.1 skrll symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
368 1.1 skrll are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
369 1.1 skrll symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
370 1.1 skrll Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
371 1.1 skrll or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
372 1.1 skrll
373 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *
374 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
375 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
376 1.1 skrll size_t symcount,
377 1.1 skrll size_t symoffset,
378 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
379 1.1 skrll void *extsym_buf,
380 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
381 1.1 skrll {
382 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
383 1.1 skrll void *alloc_ext;
384 1.1 skrll const bfd_byte *esym;
385 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
386 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
387 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
388 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
389 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
390 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
391 1.1 skrll size_t extsym_size;
392 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
393 1.1 skrll file_ptr pos;
394 1.1 skrll
395 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
396 1.1 skrll abort ();
397 1.1 skrll
398 1.1 skrll if (symcount == 0)
399 1.1 skrll return intsym_buf;
400 1.1 skrll
401 1.1 skrll /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
402 1.1 skrll shndx_hdr = NULL;
403 1.6 christos if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
404 1.6 christos {
405 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
406 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
407 1.6 christos
408 1.6 christos /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
409 1.6 christos for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
410 1.6 christos if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
411 1.6 christos {
412 1.6 christos shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
413 1.6 christos break;
414 1.6 christos };
415 1.6 christos
416 1.6 christos if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
417 1.6 christos {
418 1.6 christos if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
419 1.6 christos /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
420 1.6 christos shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
421 1.6 christos /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
422 1.6 christos the index table will not be needed. */
423 1.6 christos }
424 1.6 christos }
425 1.1 skrll
426 1.1 skrll /* Read the symbols. */
427 1.1 skrll alloc_ext = NULL;
428 1.1 skrll alloc_extshndx = NULL;
429 1.1 skrll alloc_intsym = NULL;
430 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
431 1.1 skrll extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
432 1.1 skrll amt = symcount * extsym_size;
433 1.1 skrll pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
434 1.1 skrll if (extsym_buf == NULL)
435 1.1 skrll {
436 1.1 skrll alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
437 1.1 skrll extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
438 1.1 skrll }
439 1.1 skrll if (extsym_buf == NULL
440 1.1 skrll || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
441 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
442 1.1 skrll {
443 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
444 1.1 skrll goto out;
445 1.1 skrll }
446 1.1 skrll
447 1.1 skrll if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
448 1.1 skrll extshndx_buf = NULL;
449 1.1 skrll else
450 1.1 skrll {
451 1.1 skrll amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
452 1.1 skrll pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
453 1.1 skrll if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
454 1.1 skrll {
455 1.3 christos alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
456 1.3 christos bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
457 1.1 skrll extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
458 1.1 skrll }
459 1.1 skrll if (extshndx_buf == NULL
460 1.1 skrll || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
461 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
462 1.1 skrll {
463 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
464 1.1 skrll goto out;
465 1.1 skrll }
466 1.1 skrll }
467 1.1 skrll
468 1.1 skrll if (intsym_buf == NULL)
469 1.1 skrll {
470 1.3 christos alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
471 1.3 christos bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
472 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
473 1.1 skrll if (intsym_buf == NULL)
474 1.1 skrll goto out;
475 1.1 skrll }
476 1.1 skrll
477 1.1 skrll /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
478 1.1 skrll isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
479 1.3 christos for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
480 1.3 christos shndx = extshndx_buf;
481 1.1 skrll isym < isymend;
482 1.1 skrll esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
483 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
484 1.1 skrll {
485 1.1 skrll symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
486 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
487 1.1 skrll "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
488 1.1 skrll ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
489 1.1 skrll if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
490 1.1 skrll free (alloc_intsym);
491 1.1 skrll intsym_buf = NULL;
492 1.1 skrll goto out;
493 1.1 skrll }
494 1.1 skrll
495 1.1 skrll out:
496 1.1 skrll if (alloc_ext != NULL)
497 1.1 skrll free (alloc_ext);
498 1.1 skrll if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
499 1.1 skrll free (alloc_extshndx);
500 1.1 skrll
501 1.1 skrll return intsym_buf;
502 1.1 skrll }
503 1.1 skrll
504 1.1 skrll /* Look up a symbol name. */
505 1.1 skrll const char *
506 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
507 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
508 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
509 1.1 skrll asection *sym_sec)
510 1.1 skrll {
511 1.1 skrll const char *name;
512 1.1 skrll unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
513 1.1 skrll unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
514 1.1 skrll
515 1.1 skrll if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
516 1.1 skrll /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
517 1.1 skrll && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
518 1.1 skrll {
519 1.1 skrll iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
520 1.1 skrll shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
521 1.1 skrll }
522 1.1 skrll
523 1.1 skrll name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
524 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
525 1.1 skrll name = "(null)";
526 1.1 skrll else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
527 1.1 skrll name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
528 1.1 skrll
529 1.1 skrll return name;
530 1.1 skrll }
531 1.1 skrll
532 1.1 skrll /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
533 1.1 skrll sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
534 1.1 skrll pointers. */
535 1.1 skrll
536 1.1 skrll typedef union elf_internal_group {
537 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
538 1.1 skrll unsigned int flags;
539 1.1 skrll } Elf_Internal_Group;
540 1.1 skrll
541 1.1 skrll /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
542 1.1 skrll signature just a string? */
543 1.1 skrll
544 1.1 skrll static const char *
545 1.1 skrll group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
546 1.1 skrll {
547 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
548 1.1 skrll unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
549 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
550 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
551 1.1 skrll
552 1.1 skrll /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
553 1.1 skrll that it is a symbol table section. */
554 1.1 skrll if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
555 1.1 skrll return NULL;
556 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
557 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
558 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
559 1.1 skrll return NULL;
560 1.1 skrll
561 1.1 skrll /* Go read the symbol. */
562 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
563 1.1 skrll if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
564 1.1 skrll &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
565 1.1 skrll return NULL;
566 1.1 skrll
567 1.1 skrll return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
568 1.1 skrll }
569 1.1 skrll
570 1.1 skrll /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
571 1.1 skrll
572 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
573 1.1 skrll setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
574 1.1 skrll {
575 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
576 1.1 skrll
577 1.1 skrll /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
578 1.1 skrll is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
579 1.1 skrll if (num_group == 0)
580 1.1 skrll {
581 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, shnum;
582 1.1 skrll
583 1.1 skrll /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
584 1.1 skrll section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
585 1.1 skrll shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
586 1.1 skrll num_group = 0;
587 1.1 skrll
588 1.6 christos #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
589 1.1 skrll ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
590 1.6 christos && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
591 1.1 skrll && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
592 1.1 skrll && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
593 1.1 skrll
594 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
595 1.1 skrll {
596 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
597 1.1 skrll
598 1.6 christos if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
599 1.1 skrll num_group += 1;
600 1.1 skrll }
601 1.1 skrll
602 1.1 skrll if (num_group == 0)
603 1.1 skrll {
604 1.1 skrll num_group = (unsigned) -1;
605 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
606 1.1 skrll }
607 1.1 skrll else
608 1.1 skrll {
609 1.1 skrll /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
610 1.1 skrll so we can find them quickly. */
611 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
612 1.1 skrll
613 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
614 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
615 1.3 christos bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
616 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
617 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
618 1.1 skrll
619 1.1 skrll num_group = 0;
620 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
621 1.1 skrll {
622 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
623 1.1 skrll
624 1.6 christos if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
625 1.1 skrll {
626 1.1 skrll unsigned char *src;
627 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
628 1.1 skrll
629 1.1 skrll /* Add to list of sections. */
630 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
631 1.1 skrll num_group += 1;
632 1.1 skrll
633 1.1 skrll /* Read the raw contents. */
634 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
635 1.1 skrll amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
636 1.3 christos shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
637 1.3 christos bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
638 1.1 skrll /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
639 1.1 skrll if (shdr->contents == NULL)
640 1.1 skrll {
641 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler
642 1.6 christos (_("%B: corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
643 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
644 1.6 christos -- num_group;
645 1.6 christos continue;
646 1.1 skrll }
647 1.1 skrll
648 1.1 skrll memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
649 1.1 skrll
650 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
651 1.1 skrll || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
652 1.1 skrll != shdr->sh_size))
653 1.6 christos {
654 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler
655 1.6 christos (_("%B: invalid size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
656 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
657 1.6 christos -- num_group;
658 1.6 christos /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even partially
659 1.6 christos corrupt, do not allow any of the contents to be used. */
660 1.6 christos memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
661 1.6 christos continue;
662 1.6 christos }
663 1.1 skrll
664 1.1 skrll /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
665 1.1 skrll array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
666 1.1 skrll to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
667 1.1 skrll pointers. */
668 1.1 skrll src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
669 1.1 skrll dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
670 1.6 christos
671 1.1 skrll while (1)
672 1.1 skrll {
673 1.1 skrll unsigned int idx;
674 1.1 skrll
675 1.1 skrll src -= 4;
676 1.1 skrll --dest;
677 1.1 skrll idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
678 1.1 skrll if (src == shdr->contents)
679 1.1 skrll {
680 1.1 skrll dest->flags = idx;
681 1.1 skrll if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
682 1.1 skrll shdr->bfd_section->flags
683 1.1 skrll |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
684 1.1 skrll break;
685 1.1 skrll }
686 1.1 skrll if (idx >= shnum)
687 1.1 skrll {
688 1.1 skrll ((*_bfd_error_handler)
689 1.1 skrll (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
690 1.1 skrll idx = 0;
691 1.1 skrll }
692 1.1 skrll dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
693 1.1 skrll }
694 1.1 skrll }
695 1.1 skrll }
696 1.6 christos
697 1.6 christos /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
698 1.6 christos if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
699 1.6 christos {
700 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
701 1.6 christos
702 1.6 christos /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
703 1.6 christos if (num_group == 0)
704 1.6 christos {
705 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
706 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
707 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
708 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
709 1.6 christos }
710 1.6 christos }
711 1.1 skrll }
712 1.1 skrll }
713 1.1 skrll
714 1.1 skrll if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
715 1.1 skrll {
716 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
717 1.1 skrll
718 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
719 1.1 skrll {
720 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
721 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
722 1.1 skrll unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
723 1.1 skrll
724 1.1 skrll /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
725 1.1 skrll section is a member. */
726 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
727 1.1 skrll if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
728 1.1 skrll {
729 1.1 skrll asection *s = NULL;
730 1.1 skrll
731 1.1 skrll /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
732 1.1 skrll other members to see if any others are linked via
733 1.1 skrll next_in_group. */
734 1.1 skrll idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
735 1.1 skrll n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
736 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
737 1.1 skrll if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
738 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
739 1.1 skrll break;
740 1.1 skrll if (n_elt != 0)
741 1.1 skrll {
742 1.1 skrll /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
743 1.1 skrll insert current section in circular list. */
744 1.1 skrll elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
745 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
746 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
747 1.1 skrll }
748 1.1 skrll else
749 1.1 skrll {
750 1.1 skrll const char *gname;
751 1.1 skrll
752 1.1 skrll gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
753 1.1 skrll if (gname == NULL)
754 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
755 1.1 skrll elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
756 1.1 skrll
757 1.1 skrll /* Start a circular list with one element. */
758 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
759 1.1 skrll }
760 1.1 skrll
761 1.1 skrll /* If the group section has been created, point to the
762 1.1 skrll new member. */
763 1.1 skrll if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
764 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
765 1.1 skrll
766 1.1 skrll i = num_group - 1;
767 1.1 skrll break;
768 1.1 skrll }
769 1.1 skrll }
770 1.1 skrll }
771 1.1 skrll
772 1.1 skrll if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
773 1.1 skrll {
774 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
775 1.1 skrll abfd, newsect);
776 1.6 christos return FALSE;
777 1.1 skrll }
778 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
779 1.1 skrll }
780 1.1 skrll
781 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
782 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
783 1.1 skrll {
784 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
785 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
786 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
787 1.1 skrll asection *s;
788 1.1 skrll
789 1.1 skrll /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
790 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
791 1.1 skrll {
792 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
793 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
794 1.1 skrll {
795 1.1 skrll unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
796 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
797 1.1 skrll not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
798 1.1 skrll get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
799 1.1 skrll if (elfsec == 0)
800 1.1 skrll {
801 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
802 1.1 skrll if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
803 1.1 skrll bed->link_order_error_handler
804 1.1 skrll (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
805 1.1 skrll abfd, s);
806 1.1 skrll }
807 1.1 skrll else
808 1.1 skrll {
809 1.3 christos asection *linksec = NULL;
810 1.1 skrll
811 1.1 skrll if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
812 1.1 skrll {
813 1.1 skrll this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
814 1.3 christos linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
815 1.1 skrll }
816 1.1 skrll
817 1.1 skrll /* PR 1991, 2008:
818 1.1 skrll Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
819 1.1 skrll sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
820 1.3 christos if (linksec == NULL)
821 1.1 skrll {
822 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
823 1.1 skrll (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
824 1.1 skrll s->owner, s, elfsec);
825 1.1 skrll result = FALSE;
826 1.1 skrll }
827 1.1 skrll
828 1.3 christos elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
829 1.1 skrll }
830 1.1 skrll }
831 1.1 skrll }
832 1.1 skrll
833 1.1 skrll /* Process section groups. */
834 1.1 skrll if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
835 1.1 skrll return result;
836 1.1 skrll
837 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
838 1.1 skrll {
839 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
840 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
841 1.6 christos unsigned int n_elt;
842 1.6 christos
843 1.6 christos /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
844 1.6 christos if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
845 1.6 christos {
846 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
847 1.6 christos (_("%B: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
848 1.6 christos abfd, i);
849 1.6 christos result = FALSE;
850 1.6 christos continue;
851 1.6 christos }
852 1.6 christos
853 1.6 christos idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
854 1.6 christos n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
855 1.1 skrll
856 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
857 1.1 skrll if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
858 1.1 skrll elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
859 1.1 skrll else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
860 1.1 skrll || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
861 1.1 skrll /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
862 1.1 skrll output object files. We adjust the group section size here
863 1.1 skrll so that relocatable link will work correctly when
864 1.1 skrll relocation sections are in section group in input object
865 1.1 skrll files. */
866 1.1 skrll shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
867 1.1 skrll else
868 1.1 skrll {
869 1.1 skrll /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
870 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
871 1.1 skrll (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
872 1.1 skrll abfd,
873 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
874 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
875 1.1 skrll (elf_elfheader (abfd)
876 1.1 skrll ->e_shstrndx),
877 1.1 skrll idx->shdr->sh_name),
878 1.1 skrll shdr->bfd_section->name);
879 1.1 skrll result = FALSE;
880 1.1 skrll }
881 1.1 skrll }
882 1.1 skrll return result;
883 1.1 skrll }
884 1.1 skrll
885 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
886 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
887 1.1 skrll {
888 1.1 skrll return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
889 1.1 skrll }
890 1.1 skrll
891 1.6 christos static char *
892 1.6 christos convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
893 1.6 christos {
894 1.6 christos unsigned int len = strlen (name);
895 1.6 christos char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
896 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
897 1.6 christos return NULL;
898 1.6 christos new_name[0] = '.';
899 1.6 christos new_name[1] = 'z';
900 1.6 christos memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
901 1.6 christos return new_name;
902 1.6 christos }
903 1.6 christos
904 1.6 christos static char *
905 1.6 christos convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
906 1.6 christos {
907 1.6 christos unsigned int len = strlen (name);
908 1.6 christos char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
909 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
910 1.6 christos return NULL;
911 1.6 christos new_name[0] = '.';
912 1.6 christos memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
913 1.6 christos return new_name;
914 1.6 christos }
915 1.6 christos
916 1.1 skrll /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
917 1.1 skrll BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
918 1.1 skrll
919 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
920 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
921 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
922 1.1 skrll const char *name,
923 1.1 skrll int shindex)
924 1.1 skrll {
925 1.1 skrll asection *newsect;
926 1.1 skrll flagword flags;
927 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
928 1.1 skrll
929 1.1 skrll if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
930 1.3 christos return TRUE;
931 1.1 skrll
932 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
933 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
934 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
935 1.1 skrll
936 1.1 skrll hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
937 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
938 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
939 1.1 skrll
940 1.1 skrll /* Always use the real type/flags. */
941 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
942 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
943 1.1 skrll
944 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
945 1.1 skrll
946 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
947 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
948 1.1 skrll || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
949 1.1 skrll bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
950 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
951 1.1 skrll
952 1.1 skrll flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
953 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
954 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
955 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
956 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
957 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
958 1.1 skrll {
959 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
960 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
961 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_LOAD;
962 1.1 skrll }
963 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
964 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_READONLY;
965 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
966 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_CODE;
967 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
968 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_DATA;
969 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
970 1.1 skrll {
971 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_MERGE;
972 1.1 skrll newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
973 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
974 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
975 1.1 skrll }
976 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
977 1.1 skrll if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
978 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
979 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
980 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
981 1.3 christos if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
982 1.3 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
983 1.1 skrll
984 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
985 1.1 skrll {
986 1.1 skrll /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
987 1.1 skrll not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
988 1.1 skrll if (name [0] == '.')
989 1.1 skrll {
990 1.5 christos const char *p;
991 1.5 christos int n;
992 1.5 christos if (name[1] == 'd')
993 1.5 christos p = ".debug", n = 6;
994 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
995 1.5 christos p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
996 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
997 1.5 christos p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
998 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'l')
999 1.5 christos p = ".line", n = 5;
1000 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 's')
1001 1.5 christos p = ".stab", n = 5;
1002 1.5 christos else if (name[1] == 'z')
1003 1.5 christos p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1004 1.5 christos else
1005 1.5 christos p = NULL, n = 0;
1006 1.5 christos if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1007 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1008 1.1 skrll }
1009 1.1 skrll }
1010 1.1 skrll
1011 1.1 skrll /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1012 1.1 skrll only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1013 1.1 skrll g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1014 1.1 skrll The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1015 1.1 skrll are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1016 1.1 skrll all but one of the sections. */
1017 1.1 skrll if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1018 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1019 1.1 skrll flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1020 1.1 skrll
1021 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1022 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1023 1.1 skrll if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1024 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1025 1.1 skrll
1026 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1027 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1028 1.1 skrll
1029 1.1 skrll /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1030 1.1 skrll separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1031 1.1 skrll PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1032 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1033 1.1 skrll {
1034 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents;
1035 1.1 skrll
1036 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1037 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1038 1.1 skrll
1039 1.1 skrll elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, -1);
1040 1.1 skrll free (contents);
1041 1.1 skrll }
1042 1.1 skrll
1043 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1044 1.1 skrll {
1045 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1046 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, nload;
1047 1.1 skrll
1048 1.1 skrll /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1049 1.1 skrll p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1050 1.1 skrll one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1051 1.1 skrll so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1052 1.1 skrll phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1053 1.1 skrll for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1054 1.1 skrll if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1055 1.1 skrll break;
1056 1.1 skrll else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1057 1.1 skrll ++nload;
1058 1.1 skrll if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1059 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1060 1.1 skrll
1061 1.1 skrll phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1062 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1063 1.1 skrll {
1064 1.3 christos if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1065 1.3 christos && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1066 1.3 christos || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1067 1.3 christos && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1068 1.1 skrll {
1069 1.1 skrll if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1070 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1071 1.1 skrll + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1072 1.1 skrll else
1073 1.1 skrll /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1074 1.1 skrll sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1075 1.1 skrll is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1076 1.1 skrll Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1077 1.1 skrll the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1078 1.1 skrll segment will contain sections with contiguous
1079 1.1 skrll LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1080 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1081 1.1 skrll + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1082 1.1 skrll
1083 1.1 skrll /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1084 1.1 skrll offsets whether a section with zero size should
1085 1.1 skrll be placed at the end of one segment or the
1086 1.1 skrll beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1087 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1088 1.1 skrll && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1089 1.1 skrll <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1090 1.1 skrll break;
1091 1.1 skrll }
1092 1.1 skrll }
1093 1.1 skrll }
1094 1.1 skrll
1095 1.3 christos /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1096 1.3 christos .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1097 1.3 christos if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1098 1.3 christos && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1099 1.3 christos || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1100 1.3 christos {
1101 1.3 christos enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1102 1.6 christos int compression_header_size;
1103 1.6 christos bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1104 1.6 christos bfd_boolean compressed
1105 1.6 christos = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1106 1.6 christos &compression_header_size,
1107 1.6 christos &uncompressed_size);
1108 1.3 christos
1109 1.6 christos if (compressed)
1110 1.3 christos {
1111 1.3 christos /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1112 1.3 christos if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1113 1.3 christos action = decompress;
1114 1.3 christos }
1115 1.6 christos
1116 1.6 christos /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1117 1.6 christos section. Check if we should compress. */
1118 1.6 christos if (action == nothing)
1119 1.6 christos {
1120 1.6 christos if (newsect->size != 0
1121 1.6 christos && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1122 1.6 christos && compression_header_size >= 0
1123 1.6 christos && uncompressed_size > 0
1124 1.6 christos && (!compressed
1125 1.6 christos || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1126 1.6 christos != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1127 1.3 christos action = compress;
1128 1.6 christos else
1129 1.6 christos return TRUE;
1130 1.3 christos }
1131 1.1 skrll
1132 1.6 christos if (action == compress)
1133 1.3 christos {
1134 1.3 christos if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1135 1.3 christos {
1136 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
1137 1.5 christos (_("%B: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1138 1.3 christos abfd, name);
1139 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1140 1.3 christos }
1141 1.6 christos }
1142 1.6 christos else
1143 1.6 christos {
1144 1.3 christos if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1145 1.3 christos {
1146 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
1147 1.5 christos (_("%B: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1148 1.3 christos abfd, name);
1149 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1150 1.3 christos }
1151 1.6 christos }
1152 1.1 skrll
1153 1.6 christos if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1154 1.6 christos {
1155 1.6 christos if (name[1] == 'z'
1156 1.6 christos && (action == decompress
1157 1.6 christos || (action == compress
1158 1.6 christos && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1159 1.6 christos {
1160 1.6 christos /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1161 1.6 christos that linker will consider this section as a debug
1162 1.6 christos section. */
1163 1.6 christos char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1164 1.3 christos if (new_name == NULL)
1165 1.3 christos return FALSE;
1166 1.6 christos bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1167 1.3 christos }
1168 1.1 skrll }
1169 1.6 christos else
1170 1.6 christos /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1171 1.6 christos section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1172 1.6 christos newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1173 1.1 skrll }
1174 1.3 christos
1175 1.3 christos return TRUE;
1176 1.1 skrll }
1177 1.1 skrll
1178 1.1 skrll const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
1179 1.1 skrll "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1180 1.1 skrll "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1181 1.1 skrll "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1182 1.1 skrll };
1183 1.1 skrll
1184 1.1 skrll /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1185 1.1 skrll output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1186 1.1 skrll has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1187 1.1 skrll be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1188 1.1 skrll change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1189 1.1 skrll all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1190 1.1 skrll into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1191 1.1 skrll function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1192 1.1 skrll relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1193 1.1 skrll
1194 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
1195 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1196 1.1 skrll arelent *reloc_entry,
1197 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
1198 1.1 skrll void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1199 1.1 skrll asection *input_section,
1200 1.1 skrll bfd *output_bfd,
1201 1.1 skrll char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1202 1.1 skrll {
1203 1.1 skrll if (output_bfd != NULL
1204 1.1 skrll && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1205 1.1 skrll && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1206 1.1 skrll || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1207 1.1 skrll {
1208 1.1 skrll reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1209 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_ok;
1210 1.1 skrll }
1211 1.1 skrll
1212 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_continue;
1213 1.1 skrll }
1214 1.1 skrll
1215 1.1 skrll /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1217 1.1 skrll another. */
1218 1.1 skrll
1219 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1220 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1221 1.1 skrll {
1222 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1223 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1224 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1225 1.6 christos
1226 1.6 christos if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1227 1.6 christos {
1228 1.6 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1229 1.6 christos elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1230 1.1 skrll }
1231 1.1 skrll
1232 1.6 christos elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1233 1.6 christos
1234 1.6 christos /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1235 1.6 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1236 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1237 1.1 skrll
1238 1.1 skrll /* Copy object attributes. */
1239 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1240 1.6 christos
1241 1.6 christos /* This is an feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug: When a section's type
1242 1.6 christos is changed to NOBITS, we preserve the sh_link and sh_info fields so that
1243 1.6 christos they can be matched up with the original. */
1244 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr ** iheaders = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1245 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1246 1.6 christos
1247 1.6 christos if (iheaders != NULL && oheaders != NULL)
1248 1.6 christos {
1249 1.6 christos unsigned int i;
1250 1.6 christos
1251 1.6 christos for (i = 0; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1252 1.6 christos {
1253 1.6 christos unsigned int j;
1254 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1255 1.6 christos
1256 1.6 christos if (oheader == NULL
1257 1.6 christos || oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1258 1.6 christos || oheader->sh_size == 0
1259 1.6 christos || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1260 1.6 christos continue;
1261 1.6 christos
1262 1.6 christos /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1263 1.6 christos FIXME: We could use something better than a linear scan here.
1264 1.6 christos Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1265 1.6 christos is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1266 1.6 christos for (j = 0; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1267 1.6 christos {
1268 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1269 1.6 christos
1270 1.6 christos /* Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections
1271 1.6 christos into SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type
1272 1.6 christos matches any input type. */
1273 1.6 christos if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1274 1.6 christos || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1275 1.6 christos && iheader->sh_flags == oheader->sh_flags
1276 1.6 christos && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1277 1.6 christos && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1278 1.6 christos && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1279 1.6 christos && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1280 1.6 christos && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1281 1.6 christos || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1282 1.6 christos {
1283 1.6 christos /* Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1284 1.6 christos The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1285 1.6 christos relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1286 1.6 christos the same location as they were in the input BFD. But the
1287 1.6 christos whole point of this action is to preserve the original
1288 1.6 christos values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so that they
1289 1.6 christos can be matched up with the section headers in the
1290 1.6 christos original file. So strictly speaking we may be creating
1291 1.6 christos an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file that just
1292 1.6 christos contains debug info and only for sections without any
1293 1.6 christos contents. */
1294 1.6 christos if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1295 1.6 christos oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1296 1.6 christos if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1297 1.6 christos oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1298 1.6 christos break;
1299 1.6 christos }
1300 1.6 christos }
1301 1.6 christos }
1302 1.6 christos }
1303 1.1 skrll
1304 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1305 1.1 skrll }
1306 1.1 skrll
1307 1.1 skrll static const char *
1308 1.1 skrll get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1309 1.1 skrll {
1310 1.1 skrll const char *pt;
1311 1.1 skrll switch (p_type)
1312 1.1 skrll {
1313 1.1 skrll case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1314 1.1 skrll case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1315 1.1 skrll case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1316 1.1 skrll case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1317 1.1 skrll case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1318 1.1 skrll case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1319 1.1 skrll case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1320 1.1 skrll case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1321 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1322 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1323 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1324 1.1 skrll default: pt = NULL; break;
1325 1.1 skrll }
1326 1.1 skrll return pt;
1327 1.1 skrll }
1328 1.1 skrll
1329 1.1 skrll /* Print out the program headers. */
1330 1.1 skrll
1331 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1332 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1333 1.3 christos {
1334 1.1 skrll FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1335 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1336 1.1 skrll asection *s;
1337 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1338 1.1 skrll
1339 1.1 skrll p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1340 1.1 skrll if (p != NULL)
1341 1.1 skrll {
1342 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, c;
1343 1.1 skrll
1344 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1345 1.1 skrll c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1346 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1347 1.1 skrll {
1348 1.1 skrll const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1349 1.1 skrll char buf[20];
1350 1.1 skrll
1351 1.1 skrll if (pt == NULL)
1352 1.1 skrll {
1353 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1354 1.1 skrll pt = buf;
1355 1.1 skrll }
1356 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1357 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1358 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1359 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1360 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1361 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1362 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1363 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1364 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1365 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1366 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1367 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1368 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1369 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1370 1.1 skrll (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1371 1.1 skrll if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1372 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1373 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1374 1.1 skrll }
1375 1.1 skrll }
1376 1.1 skrll
1377 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1378 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
1379 1.1 skrll {
1380 1.1 skrll unsigned int elfsec;
1381 1.1 skrll unsigned long shlink;
1382 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1383 1.1 skrll size_t extdynsize;
1384 1.1 skrll void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1385 1.1 skrll
1386 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1387 1.1 skrll
1388 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1389 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1390 1.1 skrll
1391 1.1 skrll elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1392 1.1 skrll if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1393 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1394 1.1 skrll shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1395 1.1 skrll
1396 1.1 skrll extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1397 1.1 skrll swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1398 1.1 skrll
1399 1.6 christos extdyn = dynbuf;
1400 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1401 1.6 christos if (s->size < extdynsize)
1402 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1403 1.6 christos extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1404 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1405 1.6 christos Fix range check. */
1406 1.1 skrll for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1407 1.1 skrll {
1408 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1409 1.1 skrll const char *name = "";
1410 1.1 skrll char ab[20];
1411 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean stringp;
1412 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1413 1.1 skrll
1414 1.1 skrll (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1415 1.1 skrll
1416 1.1 skrll if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1417 1.1 skrll break;
1418 1.1 skrll
1419 1.1 skrll stringp = FALSE;
1420 1.1 skrll switch (dyn.d_tag)
1421 1.1 skrll {
1422 1.1 skrll default:
1423 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1424 1.1 skrll name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1425 1.1 skrll
1426 1.1 skrll if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1427 1.1 skrll {
1428 1.1 skrll sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
1429 1.1 skrll name = ab;
1430 1.1 skrll }
1431 1.1 skrll break;
1432 1.1 skrll
1433 1.1 skrll case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1434 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1435 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1436 1.1 skrll case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1437 1.1 skrll case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1438 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1439 1.1 skrll case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1440 1.1 skrll case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1441 1.1 skrll case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1442 1.1 skrll case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1443 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1444 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1445 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1446 1.1 skrll case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1447 1.1 skrll case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1448 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1449 1.1 skrll case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1450 1.1 skrll case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1451 1.1 skrll case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1452 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1453 1.1 skrll case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1454 1.1 skrll case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1455 1.1 skrll case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1456 1.1 skrll case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1457 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1458 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1459 1.1 skrll case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1460 1.1 skrll case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1461 1.1 skrll case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1462 1.1 skrll case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1463 1.1 skrll case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1464 1.1 skrll case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1465 1.1 skrll case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1466 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1467 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1468 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1469 1.1 skrll case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1470 1.1 skrll case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1471 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1472 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1473 1.1 skrll case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1474 1.1 skrll case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1475 1.1 skrll case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1476 1.1 skrll case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1477 1.1 skrll case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1478 1.1 skrll case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1479 1.1 skrll case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1480 1.1 skrll case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1481 1.1 skrll case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1482 1.1 skrll case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1483 1.1 skrll case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1484 1.1 skrll case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1485 1.1 skrll case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1486 1.1 skrll case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1487 1.1 skrll case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1488 1.1 skrll case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1489 1.1 skrll case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1490 1.1 skrll case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1491 1.1 skrll }
1492 1.1 skrll
1493 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1494 1.1 skrll if (! stringp)
1495 1.1 skrll {
1496 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "0x");
1497 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1498 1.1 skrll }
1499 1.1 skrll else
1500 1.1 skrll {
1501 1.1 skrll const char *string;
1502 1.1 skrll unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1503 1.1 skrll
1504 1.1 skrll string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1505 1.1 skrll if (string == NULL)
1506 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
1507 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1508 1.1 skrll }
1509 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1510 1.1 skrll }
1511 1.1 skrll
1512 1.1 skrll free (dynbuf);
1513 1.1 skrll dynbuf = NULL;
1514 1.1 skrll }
1515 1.1 skrll
1516 1.1 skrll if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1517 1.1 skrll || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1518 1.1 skrll {
1519 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1520 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1521 1.1 skrll }
1522 1.1 skrll
1523 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1524 1.1 skrll {
1525 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1526 1.1 skrll
1527 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1528 1.1 skrll for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1529 1.1 skrll {
1530 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1531 1.1 skrll t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1532 1.1 skrll t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1533 1.1 skrll if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1534 1.1 skrll {
1535 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1536 1.1 skrll
1537 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\t");
1538 1.1 skrll for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1539 1.1 skrll a != NULL;
1540 1.1 skrll a = a->vda_nextptr)
1541 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "%s ",
1542 1.1 skrll a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1543 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, "\n");
1544 1.1 skrll }
1545 1.1 skrll }
1546 1.1 skrll }
1547 1.1 skrll
1548 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1549 1.1 skrll {
1550 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1551 1.1 skrll
1552 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1553 1.1 skrll for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1554 1.1 skrll {
1555 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1556 1.1 skrll
1557 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1558 1.1 skrll t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1559 1.1 skrll for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1560 1.1 skrll fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1561 1.1 skrll a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1562 1.1 skrll a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1563 1.1 skrll }
1564 1.1 skrll }
1565 1.1 skrll
1566 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
1567 1.1 skrll
1568 1.1 skrll error_return:
1569 1.1 skrll if (dynbuf != NULL)
1570 1.1 skrll free (dynbuf);
1571 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
1572 1.1 skrll }
1573 1.6 christos
1574 1.6 christos /* Get version string. */
1575 1.6 christos
1576 1.6 christos const char *
1577 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1578 1.6 christos bfd_boolean *hidden)
1579 1.6 christos {
1580 1.6 christos const char *version_string = NULL;
1581 1.6 christos if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1582 1.6 christos && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1583 1.6 christos {
1584 1.6 christos unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1585 1.6 christos
1586 1.6 christos *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1587 1.6 christos vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1588 1.6 christos
1589 1.6 christos if (vernum == 0)
1590 1.6 christos version_string = "";
1591 1.6 christos else if (vernum == 1)
1592 1.6 christos version_string = "Base";
1593 1.6 christos else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1594 1.6 christos version_string =
1595 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1596 1.6 christos else
1597 1.6 christos {
1598 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1599 1.6 christos
1600 1.6 christos version_string = "";
1601 1.6 christos for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1602 1.6 christos t != NULL;
1603 1.6 christos t = t->vn_nextref)
1604 1.6 christos {
1605 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1606 1.6 christos
1607 1.6 christos for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1608 1.6 christos {
1609 1.6 christos if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1610 1.6 christos {
1611 1.6 christos version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1612 1.6 christos break;
1613 1.6 christos }
1614 1.6 christos }
1615 1.6 christos }
1616 1.6 christos }
1617 1.6 christos }
1618 1.6 christos return version_string;
1619 1.6 christos }
1620 1.1 skrll
1621 1.1 skrll /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1622 1.1 skrll
1623 1.1 skrll void
1624 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1625 1.1 skrll void *filep,
1626 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
1627 1.1 skrll bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1628 1.3 christos {
1629 1.1 skrll FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1630 1.1 skrll switch (how)
1631 1.1 skrll {
1632 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1633 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1634 1.1 skrll break;
1635 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1636 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, "elf ");
1637 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1638 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
1639 1.1 skrll break;
1640 1.1 skrll case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1641 1.1 skrll {
1642 1.1 skrll const char *section_name;
1643 1.1 skrll const char *name = NULL;
1644 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1645 1.1 skrll unsigned char st_other;
1646 1.6 christos bfd_vma val;
1647 1.6 christos const char *version_string;
1648 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean hidden;
1649 1.1 skrll
1650 1.1 skrll section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1651 1.1 skrll
1652 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1653 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1654 1.1 skrll name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1655 1.1 skrll
1656 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
1657 1.1 skrll {
1658 1.1 skrll name = symbol->name;
1659 1.1 skrll bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1660 1.1 skrll }
1661 1.1 skrll
1662 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1663 1.1 skrll /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1664 1.1 skrll we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1665 1.1 skrll For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1666 1.1 skrll we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1667 1.1 skrll if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1668 1.1 skrll val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1669 1.1 skrll else
1670 1.1 skrll val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1671 1.1 skrll bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1672 1.1 skrll
1673 1.6 christos /* If we have version information, print it. */
1674 1.6 christos version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1675 1.6 christos symbol,
1676 1.6 christos &hidden);
1677 1.1 skrll if (version_string)
1678 1.6 christos {
1679 1.1 skrll if (!hidden)
1680 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1681 1.1 skrll else
1682 1.1 skrll {
1683 1.1 skrll int i;
1684 1.1 skrll
1685 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1686 1.1 skrll for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1687 1.1 skrll putc (' ', file);
1688 1.1 skrll }
1689 1.1 skrll }
1690 1.1 skrll
1691 1.1 skrll /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1692 1.1 skrll st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1693 1.1 skrll
1694 1.1 skrll switch (st_other)
1695 1.1 skrll {
1696 1.1 skrll case 0: break;
1697 1.1 skrll case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1698 1.1 skrll case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1699 1.1 skrll case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1700 1.1 skrll default:
1701 1.1 skrll /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1702 1.1 skrll everything hex. */
1703 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1704 1.1 skrll }
1705 1.1 skrll
1706 1.1 skrll fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1707 1.1 skrll }
1708 1.1 skrll break;
1709 1.1 skrll }
1710 1.1 skrll }
1711 1.1 skrll
1712 1.1 skrll /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1714 1.1 skrll
1715 1.1 skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1716 1.1 skrll
1717 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
1718 1.1 skrll bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1719 1.1 skrll {
1720 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1721 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1722 1.6 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1723 1.6 christos const char *name;
1724 1.6 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
1725 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
1726 1.1 skrll static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
1727 1.1 skrll static unsigned int nesting = 0;
1728 1.1 skrll
1729 1.1 skrll if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1730 1.6 christos return FALSE;
1731 1.6 christos
1732 1.6 christos if (++ nesting > 3)
1733 1.6 christos {
1734 1.6 christos /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
1735 1.6 christos sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
1736 1.6 christos loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
1737 1.6 christos already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
1738 1.6 christos we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
1739 1.6 christos can expect to recurse at least once.
1740 1.6 christos
1741 1.6 christos FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
1742 1.6 christos rather than being held in a static pointer. */
1743 1.6 christos
1744 1.6 christos if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
1745 1.6 christos sections_being_created = NULL;
1746 1.6 christos if (sections_being_created == NULL)
1747 1.6 christos {
1748 1.6 christos /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
1749 1.6 christos sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
1750 1.6 christos bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
1751 1.6 christos sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
1752 1.6 christos }
1753 1.6 christos if (sections_being_created [shindex])
1754 1.6 christos {
1755 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
1756 1.6 christos (_("%B: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
1757 1.6 christos return FALSE;
1758 1.6 christos }
1759 1.6 christos sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
1760 1.1 skrll }
1761 1.1 skrll
1762 1.1 skrll hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
1763 1.1 skrll ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1764 1.1 skrll name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
1765 1.6 christos hdr->sh_name);
1766 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
1767 1.1 skrll goto fail;
1768 1.1 skrll
1769 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1770 1.1 skrll switch (hdr->sh_type)
1771 1.1 skrll {
1772 1.6 christos case SHT_NULL:
1773 1.1 skrll /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
1774 1.6 christos goto success;
1775 1.6 christos
1776 1.6 christos case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
1777 1.6 christos case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
1778 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
1779 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
1780 1.1 skrll case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
1781 1.1 skrll case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
1782 1.1 skrll case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
1783 1.6 christos case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
1784 1.6 christos case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
1785 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1786 1.1 skrll goto success;
1787 1.1 skrll
1788 1.6 christos case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
1789 1.6 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1790 1.3 christos goto fail;
1791 1.3 christos
1792 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
1793 1.3 christos {
1794 1.3 christos /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
1795 1.3 christos field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
1796 1.3 christos switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
1797 1.3 christos {
1798 1.3 christos case bfd_arch_i386:
1799 1.3 christos case bfd_arch_sparc:
1800 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
1801 1.3 christos || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
1802 1.3 christos break;
1803 1.6 christos /* Otherwise fall through. */
1804 1.3 christos default:
1805 1.3 christos goto fail;
1806 1.3 christos }
1807 1.6 christos }
1808 1.3 christos else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
1809 1.1 skrll goto fail;
1810 1.1 skrll else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
1811 1.1 skrll {
1812 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
1813 1.1 skrll
1814 1.1 skrll /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
1815 1.1 skrll sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
1816 1.1 skrll string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
1817 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
1818 1.1 skrll {
1819 1.1 skrll dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
1820 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1821 1.1 skrll }
1822 1.1 skrll else
1823 1.1 skrll {
1824 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
1825 1.1 skrll
1826 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1827 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1828 1.1 skrll {
1829 1.1 skrll dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1830 1.1 skrll if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1831 1.1 skrll {
1832 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1833 1.1 skrll break;
1834 1.1 skrll }
1835 1.1 skrll }
1836 1.6 christos }
1837 1.1 skrll }
1838 1.6 christos goto success;
1839 1.1 skrll
1840 1.6 christos case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
1841 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1842 1.1 skrll goto success;
1843 1.6 christos
1844 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1845 1.2 skrll goto fail;
1846 1.5 christos
1847 1.5 christos if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1848 1.6 christos {
1849 1.5 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1850 1.5 christos goto fail;
1851 1.5 christos /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
1852 1.5 christos zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
1853 1.6 christos of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
1854 1.6 christos hdr->sh_info = 0;
1855 1.6 christos goto success;
1856 1.6 christos }
1857 1.6 christos
1858 1.6 christos /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
1859 1.6 christos Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
1860 1.6 christos if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
1861 1.6 christos {
1862 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
1863 1.6 christos (_("%B: warning: multiple symbol tables detected - ignoring the table in section %u"),
1864 1.5 christos abfd, shindex);
1865 1.1 skrll goto success;
1866 1.6 christos }
1867 1.6 christos elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1868 1.1 skrll elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
1869 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
1870 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1871 1.1 skrll
1872 1.1 skrll /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
1873 1.1 skrll SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
1874 1.1 skrll treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
1875 1.1 skrll decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
1876 1.1 skrll set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
1877 1.1 skrll linker. */
1878 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
1879 1.1 skrll && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
1880 1.6 christos && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1881 1.1 skrll shindex))
1882 1.1 skrll goto fail;
1883 1.1 skrll
1884 1.1 skrll /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
1885 1.6 christos can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
1886 1.6 christos is most likely specified by the next section header. */
1887 1.6 christos {
1888 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
1889 1.6 christos unsigned int i, num_sec;
1890 1.6 christos
1891 1.6 christos for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
1892 1.6 christos if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
1893 1.6 christos goto success;
1894 1.6 christos
1895 1.6 christos num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1896 1.6 christos for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1897 1.6 christos {
1898 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1899 1.6 christos
1900 1.6 christos if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1901 1.6 christos && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1902 1.1 skrll break;
1903 1.6 christos }
1904 1.6 christos
1905 1.1 skrll if (i == num_sec)
1906 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
1907 1.6 christos {
1908 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1909 1.1 skrll
1910 1.1 skrll if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1911 1.1 skrll && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1912 1.1 skrll break;
1913 1.6 christos }
1914 1.6 christos
1915 1.6 christos if (i != shindex)
1916 1.6 christos ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
1917 1.6 christos /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
1918 1.6 christos goto success;
1919 1.6 christos }
1920 1.1 skrll
1921 1.6 christos case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
1922 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1923 1.1 skrll goto success;
1924 1.6 christos
1925 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1926 1.5 christos goto fail;
1927 1.5 christos
1928 1.5 christos if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
1929 1.6 christos {
1930 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
1931 1.5 christos goto fail;
1932 1.5 christos
1933 1.5 christos /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
1934 1.5 christos zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
1935 1.6 christos of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
1936 1.6 christos hdr->sh_info = 0;
1937 1.6 christos goto success;
1938 1.6 christos }
1939 1.6 christos
1940 1.6 christos /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
1941 1.6 christos Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
1942 1.6 christos if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
1943 1.6 christos {
1944 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
1945 1.6 christos (_("%B: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected - ignoring the table in section %u"),
1946 1.5 christos abfd, shindex);
1947 1.1 skrll goto success;
1948 1.1 skrll }
1949 1.1 skrll elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1950 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
1951 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
1952 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1953 1.1 skrll
1954 1.6 christos /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
1955 1.6 christos section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
1956 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1957 1.6 christos goto success;
1958 1.6 christos
1959 1.6 christos case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
1960 1.1 skrll {
1961 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
1962 1.6 christos
1963 1.6 christos for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
1964 1.6 christos if (entry->ndx == shindex)
1965 1.6 christos goto success;
1966 1.6 christos
1967 1.6 christos entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
1968 1.6 christos if (entry == NULL)
1969 1.6 christos goto fail;
1970 1.6 christos entry->ndx = shindex;
1971 1.6 christos entry->hdr = * hdr;
1972 1.6 christos entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
1973 1.6 christos elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
1974 1.6 christos elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
1975 1.1 skrll goto success;
1976 1.6 christos }
1977 1.1 skrll
1978 1.6 christos case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
1979 1.6 christos if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1980 1.1 skrll goto success;
1981 1.1 skrll
1982 1.1 skrll if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
1983 1.1 skrll {
1984 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1985 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
1986 1.6 christos goto success;
1987 1.1 skrll }
1988 1.1 skrll
1989 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1990 1.1 skrll {
1991 1.1 skrll symtab_strtab:
1992 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
1993 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
1994 1.6 christos goto success;
1995 1.1 skrll }
1996 1.1 skrll
1997 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1998 1.1 skrll {
1999 1.1 skrll dynsymtab_strtab:
2000 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2001 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2002 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2003 1.6 christos /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2004 1.6 christos can handle it. */
2005 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2006 1.1 skrll shindex);
2007 1.1 skrll goto success;
2008 1.1 skrll }
2009 1.1 skrll
2010 1.1 skrll /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2011 1.1 skrll regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2012 1.1 skrll just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2013 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2014 1.1 skrll {
2015 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_sec;
2016 1.1 skrll
2017 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2018 1.1 skrll for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2019 1.1 skrll {
2020 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2021 1.1 skrll if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2022 1.1 skrll {
2023 1.6 christos /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2024 1.1 skrll if (i == shindex)
2025 1.6 christos goto fail;
2026 1.1 skrll if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2027 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2028 1.1 skrll if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2029 1.1 skrll goto symtab_strtab;
2030 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2031 1.1 skrll goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2032 1.1 skrll }
2033 1.6 christos }
2034 1.6 christos }
2035 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2036 1.1 skrll goto success;
2037 1.1 skrll
2038 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
2039 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
2040 1.1 skrll /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2041 1.3 christos {
2042 1.1 skrll asection *target_sect;
2043 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2044 1.3 christos unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2045 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2046 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
2047 1.1 skrll
2048 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_entsize
2049 1.6 christos != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2050 1.1 skrll ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2051 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2052 1.1 skrll
2053 1.1 skrll /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2054 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2055 1.1 skrll {
2056 1.1 skrll ((*_bfd_error_handler)
2057 1.6 christos (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2058 1.6 christos abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
2059 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2060 1.1 skrll shindex);
2061 1.1 skrll goto success;
2062 1.1 skrll }
2063 1.1 skrll
2064 1.1 skrll /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2065 1.1 skrll libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2066 1.1 skrll bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2067 1.1 skrll reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2068 1.3 christos them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2069 1.3 christos one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2070 1.3 christos to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2071 1.3 christos
2072 1.3 christos Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2073 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2074 1.1 skrll && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2075 1.1 skrll && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2076 1.1 skrll {
2077 1.1 skrll unsigned int scan;
2078 1.1 skrll int found;
2079 1.1 skrll
2080 1.1 skrll found = 0;
2081 1.1 skrll for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2082 1.1 skrll {
2083 1.1 skrll if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2084 1.1 skrll || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2085 1.1 skrll {
2086 1.1 skrll if (found != 0)
2087 1.1 skrll {
2088 1.1 skrll found = 0;
2089 1.1 skrll break;
2090 1.1 skrll }
2091 1.1 skrll found = scan;
2092 1.1 skrll }
2093 1.1 skrll }
2094 1.1 skrll if (found != 0)
2095 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_link = found;
2096 1.1 skrll }
2097 1.1 skrll
2098 1.1 skrll /* Get the symbol table. */
2099 1.1 skrll if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2100 1.6 christos || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2101 1.1 skrll && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2102 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2103 1.1 skrll
2104 1.1 skrll /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2105 1.1 skrll don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2106 1.1 skrll represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2107 1.3 christos try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2108 1.3 christos can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2109 1.1 skrll section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2110 1.3 christos sh_link points to the null section. */
2111 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2112 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2113 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2114 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2115 1.6 christos || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2116 1.6 christos || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2117 1.6 christos {
2118 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2119 1.6 christos shindex);
2120 1.1 skrll goto success;
2121 1.1 skrll }
2122 1.6 christos
2123 1.6 christos if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2124 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2125 1.1 skrll
2126 1.6 christos target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2127 1.1 skrll if (target_sect == NULL)
2128 1.3 christos goto fail;
2129 1.3 christos
2130 1.3 christos esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2131 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2132 1.3 christos p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2133 1.3 christos else
2134 1.6 christos p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2135 1.6 christos
2136 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2137 1.3 christos if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2138 1.3 christos goto fail;
2139 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
2140 1.6 christos hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2141 1.1 skrll if (hdr2 == NULL)
2142 1.3 christos goto fail;
2143 1.1 skrll *hdr2 = *hdr;
2144 1.1 skrll *p_hdr = hdr2;
2145 1.1 skrll elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2146 1.1 skrll target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
2147 1.1 skrll target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2148 1.1 skrll target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2149 1.1 skrll target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2150 1.1 skrll /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2151 1.3 christos its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2152 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2153 1.3 christos {
2154 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2155 1.1 skrll target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2156 1.6 christos }
2157 1.1 skrll abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2158 1.1 skrll goto success;
2159 1.1 skrll }
2160 1.1 skrll
2161 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2162 1.6 christos elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2163 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2164 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2165 1.1 skrll goto success;
2166 1.1 skrll
2167 1.6 christos case SHT_GNU_versym:
2168 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2169 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2170 1.1 skrll
2171 1.6 christos elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2172 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2173 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2174 1.1 skrll goto success;
2175 1.1 skrll
2176 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2177 1.6 christos elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2178 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2179 1.1 skrll ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2180 1.1 skrll goto success;
2181 1.6 christos
2182 1.1 skrll case SHT_SHLIB:
2183 1.1 skrll goto success;
2184 1.6 christos
2185 1.6 christos case SHT_GROUP:
2186 1.6 christos if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2187 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2188 1.6 christos
2189 1.6 christos if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2190 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2191 1.1 skrll
2192 1.1 skrll if (hdr->contents != NULL)
2193 1.6 christos {
2194 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
2195 1.1 skrll unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / sizeof (* idx);
2196 1.6 christos asection *s;
2197 1.6 christos
2198 1.1 skrll if (n_elt == 0)
2199 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2200 1.1 skrll if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
2201 1.1 skrll hdr->bfd_section->flags
2202 1.1 skrll |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
2203 1.1 skrll
2204 1.6 christos /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in. */
2205 1.1 skrll idx += n_elt;
2206 1.1 skrll
2207 1.1 skrll while (--n_elt != 0)
2208 1.1 skrll {
2209 1.1 skrll --idx;
2210 1.1 skrll
2211 1.1 skrll if (idx->shdr != NULL
2212 1.1 skrll && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
2213 1.1 skrll && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
2214 1.1 skrll {
2215 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
2216 1.1 skrll break;
2217 1.1 skrll }
2218 1.6 christos }
2219 1.1 skrll }
2220 1.1 skrll goto success;
2221 1.1 skrll
2222 1.1 skrll default:
2223 1.1 skrll /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2224 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2225 1.1 skrll || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2226 1.6 christos {
2227 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2228 1.6 christos goto fail;
2229 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2230 1.1 skrll goto success;
2231 1.1 skrll }
2232 1.1 skrll
2233 1.6 christos /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2234 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2235 1.1 skrll goto success;
2236 1.1 skrll
2237 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2238 1.1 skrll {
2239 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2240 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2241 1.1 skrll for applications? */
2242 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
2243 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
2244 1.1 skrll "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2245 1.6 christos abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2246 1.6 christos else
2247 1.6 christos {
2248 1.6 christos /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2249 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2250 1.6 christos shindex);
2251 1.1 skrll goto success;
2252 1.1 skrll }
2253 1.1 skrll }
2254 1.1 skrll else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2255 1.1 skrll && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2256 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2257 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
2258 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
2259 1.1 skrll "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
2260 1.1 skrll abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2261 1.1 skrll else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2262 1.1 skrll {
2263 1.1 skrll /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2264 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2265 1.1 skrll /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2266 1.1 skrll required to correctly process the section and the file should
2267 1.1 skrll be rejected with an error message. */
2268 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
2269 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
2270 1.1 skrll "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
2271 1.6 christos abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2272 1.6 christos else
2273 1.6 christos {
2274 1.6 christos /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2275 1.6 christos ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2276 1.1 skrll goto success;
2277 1.1 skrll }
2278 1.1 skrll }
2279 1.1 skrll else
2280 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2281 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
2282 1.1 skrll (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2283 1.6 christos abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2284 1.1 skrll
2285 1.1 skrll goto fail;
2286 1.6 christos }
2287 1.6 christos
2288 1.6 christos fail:
2289 1.6 christos ret = FALSE;
2290 1.6 christos success:
2291 1.6 christos if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2292 1.6 christos sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2293 1.6 christos if (-- nesting == 0)
2294 1.6 christos {
2295 1.6 christos sections_being_created = NULL;
2296 1.6 christos sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2297 1.1 skrll }
2298 1.1 skrll return ret;
2299 1.3 christos }
2300 1.1 skrll
2301 1.3 christos /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2302 1.3 christos
2303 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *
2304 1.3 christos bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2305 1.1 skrll bfd *abfd,
2306 1.1 skrll unsigned long r_symndx)
2307 1.1 skrll {
2308 1.1 skrll unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2309 1.1 skrll
2310 1.1 skrll if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2311 1.1 skrll {
2312 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2313 1.1 skrll unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2314 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2315 1.1 skrll
2316 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2317 1.1 skrll if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2318 1.1 skrll &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2319 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2320 1.1 skrll
2321 1.1 skrll if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2322 1.1 skrll {
2323 1.1 skrll memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2324 1.1 skrll cache->abfd = abfd;
2325 1.1 skrll }
2326 1.1 skrll cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2327 1.3 christos }
2328 1.1 skrll
2329 1.1 skrll return &cache->sym[ent];
2330 1.1 skrll }
2331 1.1 skrll
2332 1.1 skrll /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2333 1.1 skrll section. */
2334 1.3 christos
2335 1.1 skrll asection *
2336 1.3 christos bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2337 1.1 skrll {
2338 1.3 christos if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2339 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2340 1.1 skrll return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2341 1.1 skrll }
2342 1.1 skrll
2343 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2344 1.1 skrll {
2345 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2346 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2347 1.1 skrll };
2348 1.1 skrll
2349 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2350 1.1 skrll {
2351 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2352 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2353 1.1 skrll };
2354 1.1 skrll
2355 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2356 1.1 skrll {
2357 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2358 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2359 1.6 christos /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2360 1.1 skrll unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2361 1.1 skrll attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2362 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2363 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2364 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2365 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2366 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2367 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2368 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2369 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2370 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2371 1.1 skrll };
2372 1.1 skrll
2373 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2374 1.1 skrll {
2375 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2376 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2377 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2378 1.1 skrll };
2379 1.1 skrll
2380 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2381 1.3 christos {
2382 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2383 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2384 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2385 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2386 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2387 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2388 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2389 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2390 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2391 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2392 1.1 skrll };
2393 1.1 skrll
2394 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2395 1.1 skrll {
2396 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2397 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2398 1.1 skrll };
2399 1.1 skrll
2400 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2401 1.1 skrll {
2402 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2403 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2404 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2405 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2406 1.1 skrll };
2407 1.1 skrll
2408 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2409 1.1 skrll {
2410 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2411 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2412 1.1 skrll };
2413 1.1 skrll
2414 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2415 1.1 skrll {
2416 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2417 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2418 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2419 1.1 skrll };
2420 1.1 skrll
2421 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2422 1.1 skrll {
2423 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2424 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2425 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2426 1.1 skrll };
2427 1.1 skrll
2428 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2429 1.1 skrll {
2430 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2431 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2432 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2433 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2434 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2435 1.1 skrll };
2436 1.1 skrll
2437 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2438 1.1 skrll {
2439 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2440 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2441 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2442 1.1 skrll /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2443 1.1 skrll this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2444 1.1 skrll { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2445 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2446 1.1 skrll };
2447 1.1 skrll
2448 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2449 1.1 skrll {
2450 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2451 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2452 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2453 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2454 1.1 skrll };
2455 1.1 skrll
2456 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2457 1.1 skrll {
2458 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2459 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2460 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2461 1.1 skrll { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2462 1.1 skrll { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2463 1.5 christos };
2464 1.1 skrll
2465 1.1 skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2466 1.1 skrll {
2467 1.1 skrll special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2468 1.1 skrll special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2469 1.1 skrll special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2470 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'e' */
2471 1.1 skrll special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2472 1.1 skrll special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2473 1.1 skrll special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2474 1.1 skrll special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2475 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'j' */
2476 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'k' */
2477 1.1 skrll special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2478 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'm' */
2479 1.1 skrll special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2480 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'o' */
2481 1.1 skrll special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2482 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'q' */
2483 1.1 skrll special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2484 1.1 skrll special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2485 1.1 skrll special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2486 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'u' */
2487 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'v' */
2488 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'w' */
2489 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'x' */
2490 1.1 skrll NULL, /* 'y' */
2491 1.1 skrll special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2492 1.1 skrll };
2493 1.1 skrll
2494 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2495 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2496 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2497 1.1 skrll unsigned int rela)
2498 1.1 skrll {
2499 1.1 skrll int i;
2500 1.1 skrll int len;
2501 1.1 skrll
2502 1.1 skrll len = strlen (name);
2503 1.1 skrll
2504 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2505 1.1 skrll {
2506 1.1 skrll int suffix_len;
2507 1.1 skrll int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2508 1.1 skrll
2509 1.1 skrll if (len < prefix_len)
2510 1.1 skrll continue;
2511 1.1 skrll if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2512 1.1 skrll continue;
2513 1.1 skrll
2514 1.1 skrll suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2515 1.1 skrll if (suffix_len <= 0)
2516 1.1 skrll {
2517 1.1 skrll if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2518 1.1 skrll {
2519 1.1 skrll if (suffix_len == 0)
2520 1.1 skrll continue;
2521 1.1 skrll if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2522 1.1 skrll && (suffix_len == -2
2523 1.1 skrll || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2524 1.1 skrll continue;
2525 1.1 skrll }
2526 1.1 skrll }
2527 1.1 skrll else
2528 1.1 skrll {
2529 1.1 skrll if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2530 1.1 skrll continue;
2531 1.1 skrll if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2532 1.1 skrll spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2533 1.1 skrll suffix_len) != 0)
2534 1.1 skrll continue;
2535 1.1 skrll }
2536 1.1 skrll return &spec[i];
2537 1.1 skrll }
2538 1.1 skrll
2539 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2540 1.1 skrll }
2541 1.1 skrll
2542 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2543 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2544 1.1 skrll {
2545 1.1 skrll int i;
2546 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2547 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2548 1.1 skrll
2549 1.1 skrll /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2550 1.1 skrll if (sec->name == NULL)
2551 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2552 1.1 skrll
2553 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2554 1.1 skrll spec = bed->special_sections;
2555 1.1 skrll if (spec)
2556 1.1 skrll {
2557 1.1 skrll spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2558 1.1 skrll bed->special_sections,
2559 1.1 skrll sec->use_rela_p);
2560 1.1 skrll if (spec != NULL)
2561 1.1 skrll return spec;
2562 1.1 skrll }
2563 1.1 skrll
2564 1.1 skrll if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2565 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2566 1.1 skrll
2567 1.1 skrll i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2568 1.1 skrll if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2569 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2570 1.1 skrll
2571 1.1 skrll spec = special_sections[i];
2572 1.1 skrll
2573 1.1 skrll if (spec == NULL)
2574 1.1 skrll return NULL;
2575 1.1 skrll
2576 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2577 1.1 skrll }
2578 1.1 skrll
2579 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2580 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2581 1.1 skrll {
2582 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2583 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2584 1.1 skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2585 1.1 skrll
2586 1.1 skrll sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2587 1.3 christos if (sdata == NULL)
2588 1.3 christos {
2589 1.1 skrll sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2590 1.1 skrll sizeof (*sdata));
2591 1.1 skrll if (sdata == NULL)
2592 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2593 1.1 skrll sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2594 1.1 skrll }
2595 1.1 skrll
2596 1.1 skrll /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2597 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2598 1.1 skrll sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2599 1.1 skrll
2600 1.1 skrll /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2601 1.1 skrll flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2602 1.1 skrll anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2603 1.5 christos created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2604 1.5 christos set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2605 1.5 christos elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2606 1.5 christos output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2607 1.5 christos sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2608 1.1 skrll copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2609 1.1 skrll if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2610 1.1 skrll || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2611 1.5 christos {
2612 1.5 christos ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2613 1.5 christos if (ssect != NULL
2614 1.5 christos && (!sec->flags
2615 1.5 christos || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2616 1.1 skrll || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2617 1.1 skrll || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2618 1.1 skrll {
2619 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2620 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2621 1.1 skrll }
2622 1.1 skrll }
2623 1.1 skrll
2624 1.1 skrll return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2625 1.1 skrll }
2626 1.1 skrll
2627 1.1 skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2628 1.1 skrll
2629 1.1 skrll Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2630 1.1 skrll of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2631 1.1 skrll program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2632 1.1 skrll generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2633 1.1 skrll
2634 1.1 skrll Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2635 1.1 skrll (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2636 1.1 skrll system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2637 1.1 skrll but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2638 1.1 skrll file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2639 1.1 skrll of combined data+bss.
2640 1.1 skrll
2641 1.1 skrll To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2642 1.1 skrll for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2643 1.1 skrll the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2644 1.1 skrll by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2645 1.1 skrll into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2646 1.1 skrll
2647 1.1 skrll */
2648 1.1 skrll
2649 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2650 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2651 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2652 1.1 skrll int hdr_index,
2653 1.1 skrll const char *type_name)
2654 1.1 skrll {
2655 1.1 skrll asection *newsect;
2656 1.1 skrll char *name;
2657 1.1 skrll char namebuf[64];
2658 1.1 skrll size_t len;
2659 1.1 skrll int split;
2660 1.1 skrll
2661 1.1 skrll split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2662 1.1 skrll && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2663 1.1 skrll && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2664 1.1 skrll
2665 1.3 christos if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2666 1.1 skrll {
2667 1.3 christos sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2668 1.1 skrll len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2669 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2670 1.1 skrll if (!name)
2671 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2672 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2673 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2674 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
2675 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2676 1.1 skrll newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2677 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2678 1.1 skrll newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2679 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2680 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2681 1.1 skrll newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2682 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2683 1.1 skrll {
2684 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2685 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2686 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2687 1.1 skrll {
2688 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2689 1.1 skrll may be data. */
2690 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2691 1.1 skrll }
2692 1.1 skrll }
2693 1.1 skrll if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2694 1.1 skrll {
2695 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2696 1.1 skrll }
2697 1.1 skrll }
2698 1.1 skrll
2699 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2700 1.1 skrll {
2701 1.3 christos bfd_vma align;
2702 1.1 skrll
2703 1.3 christos sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2704 1.1 skrll len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2705 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2706 1.1 skrll if (!name)
2707 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2708 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2709 1.1 skrll newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2710 1.1 skrll if (newsect == NULL)
2711 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2712 1.1 skrll newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2713 1.1 skrll newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2714 1.1 skrll newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2715 1.1 skrll newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2716 1.1 skrll align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2717 1.1 skrll if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2718 1.1 skrll align = hdr->p_align;
2719 1.1 skrll newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2720 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2721 1.1 skrll {
2722 1.1 skrll /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2723 1.1 skrll not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2724 1.1 skrll assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2725 1.1 skrll executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2726 1.1 skrll section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2727 1.1 skrll always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2728 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2729 1.1 skrll newsect->size = 0;
2730 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2731 1.1 skrll if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2732 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2733 1.1 skrll }
2734 1.1 skrll if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2735 1.1 skrll newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2736 1.1 skrll }
2737 1.1 skrll
2738 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2739 1.1 skrll }
2740 1.3 christos
2741 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
2742 1.1 skrll bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2743 1.1 skrll {
2744 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2745 1.1 skrll
2746 1.1 skrll switch (hdr->p_type)
2747 1.3 christos {
2748 1.1 skrll case PT_NULL:
2749 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2750 1.3 christos
2751 1.1 skrll case PT_LOAD:
2752 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2753 1.3 christos
2754 1.1 skrll case PT_DYNAMIC:
2755 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2756 1.3 christos
2757 1.1 skrll case PT_INTERP:
2758 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2759 1.3 christos
2760 1.1 skrll case PT_NOTE:
2761 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
2762 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2763 1.1 skrll if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2764 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2765 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2766 1.3 christos
2767 1.1 skrll case PT_SHLIB:
2768 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
2769 1.3 christos
2770 1.1 skrll case PT_PHDR:
2771 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
2772 1.3 christos
2773 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
2774 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
2775 1.1 skrll "eh_frame_hdr");
2776 1.3 christos
2777 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_STACK:
2778 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
2779 1.3 christos
2780 1.1 skrll case PT_GNU_RELRO:
2781 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
2782 1.1 skrll
2783 1.1 skrll default:
2784 1.3 christos /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
2785 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2786 1.1 skrll return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
2787 1.1 skrll }
2788 1.3 christos }
2789 1.3 christos
2790 1.3 christos /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
2791 1.3 christos REL or RELA. */
2792 1.3 christos
2793 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *
2794 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
2795 1.3 christos {
2796 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
2797 1.3 christos {
2798 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
2799 1.3 christos return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
2800 1.3 christos }
2801 1.3 christos else
2802 1.3 christos return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
2803 1.6 christos }
2804 1.6 christos
2805 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
2806 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
2807 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
2808 1.6 christos const char *sec_name,
2809 1.6 christos bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
2810 1.6 christos {
2811 1.6 christos char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
2812 1.6 christos sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
2813 1.6 christos if (name == NULL)
2814 1.6 christos return FALSE;
2815 1.6 christos
2816 1.6 christos sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
2817 1.6 christos rel_hdr->sh_name =
2818 1.6 christos (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
2819 1.6 christos FALSE);
2820 1.6 christos if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2821 1.6 christos return FALSE;
2822 1.6 christos
2823 1.6 christos return TRUE;
2824 1.3 christos }
2825 1.3 christos
2826 1.3 christos /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
2827 1.3 christos containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
2828 1.1 skrll USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
2829 1.6 christos relocations. */
2830 1.1 skrll
2831 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
2832 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
2833 1.6 christos struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
2834 1.6 christos const char *sec_name,
2835 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
2836 1.3 christos bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
2837 1.1 skrll {
2838 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
2839 1.3 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2840 1.3 christos bfd_size_type amt;
2841 1.3 christos
2842 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr);
2843 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
2844 1.1 skrll rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2845 1.6 christos reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
2846 1.6 christos
2847 1.6 christos if (delay_st_name_p)
2848 1.6 christos rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
2849 1.1 skrll else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
2850 1.1 skrll use_rela_p))
2851 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
2852 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
2853 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
2854 1.1 skrll ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
2855 1.1 skrll : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
2856 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
2857 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
2858 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2859 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2860 1.1 skrll rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2861 1.1 skrll
2862 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
2863 1.3 christos }
2864 1.3 christos
2865 1.3 christos /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
2866 1.3 christos
2867 1.3 christos int
2868 1.3 christos bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
2869 1.3 christos {
2870 1.3 christos if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2871 1.3 christos && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
2872 1.3 christos return SHT_NOBITS;
2873 1.3 christos return SHT_PROGBITS;
2874 1.3 christos }
2875 1.3 christos
2876 1.3 christos struct fake_section_arg
2877 1.3 christos {
2878 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
2879 1.3 christos bfd_boolean failed;
2880 1.1 skrll };
2881 1.1 skrll
2882 1.1 skrll /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
2883 1.3 christos
2884 1.1 skrll static void
2885 1.3 christos elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
2886 1.1 skrll {
2887 1.3 christos struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
2888 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2889 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
2890 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
2891 1.6 christos unsigned int sh_type;
2892 1.1 skrll const char *name = asect->name;
2893 1.3 christos bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
2894 1.1 skrll
2895 1.1 skrll if (arg->failed)
2896 1.1 skrll {
2897 1.1 skrll /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
2898 1.1 skrll loop. */
2899 1.1 skrll return;
2900 1.3 christos }
2901 1.1 skrll
2902 1.6 christos this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
2903 1.6 christos
2904 1.6 christos if (arg->link_info)
2905 1.6 christos {
2906 1.6 christos /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
2907 1.6 christos if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
2908 1.6 christos && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
2909 1.6 christos && name[1] == 'd'
2910 1.6 christos && name[6] == '_')
2911 1.6 christos {
2912 1.6 christos /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
2913 1.6 christos compressed. */
2914 1.6 christos asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
2915 1.6 christos
2916 1.6 christos /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding setion
2917 1.6 christos name to section name section after it is compressed in
2918 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
2919 1.6 christos delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
2920 1.6 christos }
2921 1.6 christos }
2922 1.6 christos else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
2923 1.6 christos {
2924 1.6 christos /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
2925 1.6 christos if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
2926 1.6 christos {
2927 1.6 christos /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
2928 1.6 christos convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
2929 1.6 christos needed. */
2930 1.6 christos if (name[1] == 'z')
2931 1.6 christos {
2932 1.6 christos char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
2933 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
2934 1.6 christos {
2935 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
2936 1.6 christos return;
2937 1.6 christos }
2938 1.6 christos name = new_name;
2939 1.6 christos }
2940 1.6 christos }
2941 1.6 christos else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
2942 1.6 christos {
2943 1.6 christos /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
2944 1.6 christos section smaller. So only rename the section when
2945 1.6 christos compression has actually taken place. If input section
2946 1.6 christos name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
2947 1.6 christos char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
2948 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
2949 1.6 christos {
2950 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
2951 1.6 christos return;
2952 1.6 christos }
2953 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
2954 1.6 christos name = new_name;
2955 1.6 christos }
2956 1.6 christos }
2957 1.6 christos
2958 1.6 christos if (delay_st_name_p)
2959 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
2960 1.6 christos else
2961 1.6 christos {
2962 1.6 christos this_hdr->sh_name
2963 1.6 christos = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2964 1.6 christos name, FALSE);
2965 1.6 christos if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2966 1.6 christos {
2967 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
2968 1.1 skrll return;
2969 1.1 skrll }
2970 1.1 skrll }
2971 1.1 skrll
2972 1.1 skrll /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
2973 1.1 skrll
2974 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2975 1.1 skrll || asect->user_set_vma)
2976 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
2977 1.1 skrll else
2978 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2979 1.1 skrll
2980 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2981 1.6 christos this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
2982 1.6 christos this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
2983 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
2984 1.6 christos if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
2985 1.6 christos {
2986 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
2987 1.6 christos (_("%B: error: Alignment power %d of section `%A' is too big"),
2988 1.6 christos abfd, asect, asect->alignment_power);
2989 1.6 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
2990 1.1 skrll return;
2991 1.1 skrll }
2992 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
2993 1.1 skrll /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
2994 1.1 skrll copy_private_section_data. */
2995 1.1 skrll
2996 1.1 skrll this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
2997 1.1 skrll this_hdr->contents = NULL;
2998 1.1 skrll
2999 1.1 skrll /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3000 1.1 skrll asect->flags. */
3001 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3002 1.3 christos sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3003 1.1 skrll else
3004 1.1 skrll sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3005 1.1 skrll
3006 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3007 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3008 1.1 skrll else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3009 1.1 skrll && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3010 1.1 skrll && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3011 1.1 skrll {
3012 1.1 skrll /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3013 1.1 skrll allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3014 1.1 skrll non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3015 1.1 skrll to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3016 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
3017 1.1 skrll (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3018 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3019 1.1 skrll }
3020 1.1 skrll
3021 1.1 skrll switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3022 1.1 skrll {
3023 1.1 skrll default:
3024 1.1 skrll break;
3025 1.1 skrll
3026 1.1 skrll case SHT_STRTAB:
3027 1.1 skrll case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3028 1.1 skrll case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3029 1.1 skrll case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3030 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOTE:
3031 1.1 skrll case SHT_NOBITS:
3032 1.1 skrll case SHT_PROGBITS:
3033 1.1 skrll break;
3034 1.1 skrll
3035 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH:
3036 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3037 1.1 skrll break;
3038 1.1 skrll
3039 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNSYM:
3040 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3041 1.1 skrll break;
3042 1.1 skrll
3043 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3044 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3045 1.1 skrll break;
3046 1.1 skrll
3047 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
3048 1.1 skrll if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3049 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3050 1.1 skrll break;
3051 1.1 skrll
3052 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
3053 1.1 skrll if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3054 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3055 1.1 skrll break;
3056 1.1 skrll
3057 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_versym:
3058 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3059 1.1 skrll break;
3060 1.1 skrll
3061 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3062 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3063 1.1 skrll /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3064 1.1 skrll cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3065 1.1 skrll zero. */
3066 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3067 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3068 1.1 skrll else
3069 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3070 1.1 skrll || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3071 1.1 skrll break;
3072 1.1 skrll
3073 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3074 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3075 1.1 skrll /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3076 1.1 skrll cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3077 1.1 skrll zero. */
3078 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3079 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3080 1.1 skrll else
3081 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3082 1.1 skrll || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3083 1.1 skrll break;
3084 1.1 skrll
3085 1.1 skrll case SHT_GROUP:
3086 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3087 1.1 skrll break;
3088 1.1 skrll
3089 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3090 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3091 1.1 skrll break;
3092 1.1 skrll }
3093 1.1 skrll
3094 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3095 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3096 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3097 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3098 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3099 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3100 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3101 1.1 skrll {
3102 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3103 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3104 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3105 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3106 1.1 skrll }
3107 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3108 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3109 1.1 skrll if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3110 1.1 skrll {
3111 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3112 1.1 skrll if (asect->size == 0
3113 1.1 skrll && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3114 1.1 skrll {
3115 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3116 1.1 skrll
3117 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3118 1.1 skrll if (o != NULL)
3119 1.1 skrll {
3120 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3121 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3122 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3123 1.1 skrll }
3124 1.3 christos }
3125 1.3 christos }
3126 1.3 christos if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3127 1.3 christos this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3128 1.3 christos
3129 1.3 christos /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3130 1.3 christos SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3131 1.3 christos this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3132 1.3 christos create the other. */
3133 1.3 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3134 1.3 christos {
3135 1.3 christos /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3136 1.3 christos needed. */
3137 1.3 christos if (arg->link_info
3138 1.6 christos /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3139 1.6 christos && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3140 1.3 christos && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3141 1.3 christos || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3142 1.6 christos {
3143 1.6 christos if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3144 1.3 christos && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name, FALSE,
3145 1.3 christos delay_st_name_p))
3146 1.3 christos {
3147 1.3 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3148 1.3 christos return;
3149 1.6 christos }
3150 1.6 christos if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3151 1.3 christos && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name, TRUE,
3152 1.3 christos delay_st_name_p))
3153 1.3 christos {
3154 1.3 christos arg->failed = TRUE;
3155 1.3 christos return;
3156 1.3 christos }
3157 1.3 christos }
3158 1.3 christos else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3159 1.6 christos (asect->use_rela_p
3160 1.6 christos ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3161 1.6 christos name,
3162 1.3 christos asect->use_rela_p,
3163 1.3 christos delay_st_name_p))
3164 1.1 skrll arg->failed = TRUE;
3165 1.1 skrll }
3166 1.1 skrll
3167 1.1 skrll /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3168 1.1 skrll sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3169 1.3 christos if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3170 1.1 skrll && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3171 1.1 skrll arg->failed = TRUE;
3172 1.1 skrll
3173 1.1 skrll if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3174 1.1 skrll {
3175 1.1 skrll /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3176 1.1 skrll called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3177 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3178 1.1 skrll }
3179 1.2 skrll }
3180 1.2 skrll
3181 1.2 skrll /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3182 1.2 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3183 1.1 skrll when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3184 1.1 skrll from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3185 1.1 skrll
3186 1.1 skrll void
3187 1.3 christos bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3188 1.1 skrll {
3189 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3190 1.1 skrll asection *elt, *first;
3191 1.1 skrll unsigned char *loc;
3192 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean gas;
3193 1.1 skrll
3194 1.1 skrll /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3195 1.1 skrll elfxx-ia64.c. */
3196 1.1 skrll if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3197 1.1 skrll || *failedptr)
3198 1.2 skrll return;
3199 1.2 skrll
3200 1.2 skrll if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3201 1.2 skrll {
3202 1.2 skrll unsigned long symindx = 0;
3203 1.2 skrll
3204 1.2 skrll /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3205 1.2 skrll generic linker. */
3206 1.2 skrll if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3207 1.2 skrll symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3208 1.2 skrll
3209 1.2 skrll if (symindx == 0)
3210 1.2 skrll {
3211 1.2 skrll /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3212 1.2 skrll elf_section_syms. */
3213 1.2 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3214 1.2 skrll symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3215 1.2 skrll }
3216 1.2 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3217 1.2 skrll }
3218 1.2 skrll else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3219 1.2 skrll {
3220 1.2 skrll /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3221 1.2 skrll signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3222 1.2 skrll set until all local symbols are output. */
3223 1.2 skrll asection *igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3224 1.2 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3225 1.2 skrll unsigned long symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3226 1.2 skrll unsigned long extsymoff = 0;
3227 1.2 skrll struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3228 1.2 skrll
3229 1.2 skrll if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3230 1.2 skrll {
3231 1.2 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3232 1.2 skrll
3233 1.2 skrll symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3234 1.2 skrll extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3235 1.2 skrll }
3236 1.2 skrll h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3237 1.2 skrll while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3238 1.2 skrll || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3239 1.2 skrll h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3240 1.1 skrll
3241 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3242 1.1 skrll }
3243 1.1 skrll
3244 1.1 skrll /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3245 1.1 skrll gas = TRUE;
3246 1.1 skrll if (sec->contents == NULL)
3247 1.3 christos {
3248 1.1 skrll gas = FALSE;
3249 1.1 skrll sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3250 1.1 skrll
3251 1.1 skrll /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3252 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3253 1.1 skrll if (sec->contents == NULL)
3254 1.1 skrll {
3255 1.1 skrll *failedptr = TRUE;
3256 1.1 skrll return;
3257 1.1 skrll }
3258 1.1 skrll }
3259 1.1 skrll
3260 1.1 skrll loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3261 1.1 skrll
3262 1.1 skrll /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3263 1.1 skrll squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3264 1.1 skrll start of the input section group. */
3265 1.1 skrll first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3266 1.1 skrll
3267 1.1 skrll /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3268 1.1 skrll indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3269 1.1 skrll just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3270 1.1 skrll directives, not that it matters. */
3271 1.1 skrll while (elt != NULL)
3272 1.1 skrll {
3273 1.1 skrll asection *s;
3274 1.1 skrll
3275 1.1 skrll s = elt;
3276 1.3 christos if (!gas)
3277 1.3 christos s = s->output_section;
3278 1.3 christos if (s != NULL
3279 1.3 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3280 1.3 christos {
3281 1.3 christos unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3282 1.3 christos
3283 1.3 christos loc -= 4;
3284 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
3285 1.1 skrll }
3286 1.1 skrll elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3287 1.1 skrll if (elt == first)
3288 1.1 skrll break;
3289 1.1 skrll }
3290 1.1 skrll
3291 1.1 skrll if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
3292 1.1 skrll abort ();
3293 1.1 skrll
3294 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3295 1.6 christos }
3296 1.6 christos
3297 1.6 christos /* Return the section which RELOC_SEC applies to. */
3298 1.6 christos
3299 1.6 christos asection *
3300 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3301 1.6 christos {
3302 1.6 christos const char *name;
3303 1.6 christos unsigned int type;
3304 1.6 christos bfd *abfd;
3305 1.6 christos
3306 1.6 christos if (reloc_sec == NULL)
3307 1.6 christos return NULL;
3308 1.6 christos
3309 1.6 christos type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3310 1.6 christos if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3311 1.6 christos return NULL;
3312 1.6 christos
3313 1.6 christos /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3314 1.6 christos name = reloc_sec->name;
3315 1.6 christos if (type == SHT_REL)
3316 1.6 christos name += 4;
3317 1.6 christos else
3318 1.6 christos name += 5;
3319 1.6 christos
3320 1.6 christos /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3321 1.6 christos section apply to .got.plt section. */
3322 1.6 christos abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3323 1.6 christos if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3324 1.6 christos && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3325 1.6 christos {
3326 1.6 christos /* .got.plt is a linker created input section. It may be mapped
3327 1.6 christos to some other output section. Try two likely sections. */
3328 1.6 christos name = ".got.plt";
3329 1.6 christos reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3330 1.6 christos if (reloc_sec != NULL)
3331 1.6 christos return reloc_sec;
3332 1.6 christos name = ".got";
3333 1.6 christos }
3334 1.6 christos
3335 1.6 christos reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3336 1.6 christos return reloc_sec;
3337 1.1 skrll }
3338 1.1 skrll
3339 1.1 skrll /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3340 1.1 skrll too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3341 1.1 skrll in here too, while we're at it. */
3342 1.1 skrll
3343 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3344 1.1 skrll assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3345 1.1 skrll {
3346 1.6 christos struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3347 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
3348 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_number;
3349 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3350 1.1 skrll struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3351 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3352 1.1 skrll
3353 1.1 skrll section_number = 1;
3354 1.1 skrll
3355 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3356 1.6 christos
3357 1.1 skrll /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3358 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL || bfd_link_relocatable (link_info))
3359 1.1 skrll {
3360 1.1 skrll /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3361 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3362 1.1 skrll {
3363 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
3364 1.1 skrll
3365 1.1 skrll if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3366 1.1 skrll {
3367 1.1 skrll if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3368 1.1 skrll {
3369 1.1 skrll /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3370 1.1 skrll bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3371 1.1 skrll abfd->section_count--;
3372 1.1 skrll }
3373 1.1 skrll else
3374 1.1 skrll d->this_idx = section_number++;
3375 1.1 skrll }
3376 1.1 skrll }
3377 1.1 skrll }
3378 1.1 skrll
3379 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3380 1.1 skrll {
3381 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
3382 1.1 skrll
3383 1.6 christos if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3384 1.6 christos d->this_idx = section_number++;
3385 1.3 christos if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3386 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3387 1.3 christos if (d->rel.hdr)
3388 1.6 christos {
3389 1.6 christos d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3390 1.1 skrll if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3391 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3392 1.3 christos }
3393 1.1 skrll else
3394 1.3 christos d->rel.idx = 0;
3395 1.1 skrll
3396 1.3 christos if (d->rela.hdr)
3397 1.6 christos {
3398 1.6 christos d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3399 1.1 skrll if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3400 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3401 1.3 christos }
3402 1.1 skrll else
3403 1.1 skrll d->rela.idx = 0;
3404 1.6 christos }
3405 1.1 skrll
3406 1.6 christos elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3407 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3408 1.3 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3409 1.3 christos
3410 1.3 christos need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3411 1.3 christos || (link_info == NULL
3412 1.3 christos && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3413 1.1 skrll == HAS_RELOC)));
3414 1.6 christos if (need_symtab)
3415 1.1 skrll {
3416 1.1 skrll elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3417 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3418 1.6 christos if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3419 1.6 christos {
3420 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry;
3421 1.6 christos
3422 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3423 1.6 christos
3424 1.6 christos entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3425 1.6 christos entry->ndx = section_number++;
3426 1.1 skrll elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3427 1.1 skrll entry->hdr.sh_name
3428 1.6 christos = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3429 1.1 skrll ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3430 1.1 skrll if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3431 1.6 christos return FALSE;
3432 1.1 skrll }
3433 1.1 skrll elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3434 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3435 1.5 christos }
3436 1.5 christos
3437 1.5 christos if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3438 1.5 christos {
3439 1.5 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: too many sections: %u"),
3440 1.5 christos abfd, section_number);
3441 1.5 christos return FALSE;
3442 1.1 skrll }
3443 1.1 skrll
3444 1.1 skrll elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3445 1.1 skrll elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3446 1.1 skrll
3447 1.3 christos /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3448 1.3 christos indices. */
3449 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3450 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3451 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3452 1.3 christos return FALSE;
3453 1.3 christos
3454 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3455 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3456 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3457 1.1 skrll {
3458 1.1 skrll bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3459 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3460 1.1 skrll }
3461 1.1 skrll
3462 1.6 christos elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3463 1.3 christos
3464 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3465 1.6 christos if (need_symtab)
3466 1.1 skrll {
3467 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3468 1.6 christos if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3469 1.6 christos {
3470 1.6 christos elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3471 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3472 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3473 1.6 christos entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3474 1.6 christos }
3475 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3476 1.1 skrll t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3477 1.1 skrll }
3478 1.1 skrll
3479 1.1 skrll for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3480 1.1 skrll {
3481 1.3 christos asection *s;
3482 1.3 christos
3483 1.1 skrll d = elf_section_data (sec);
3484 1.3 christos
3485 1.3 christos i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3486 1.3 christos if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3487 1.3 christos i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3488 1.1 skrll if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3489 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3490 1.1 skrll
3491 1.1 skrll /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3492 1.1 skrll
3493 1.1 skrll /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3494 1.3 christos table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3495 1.1 skrll the relocation entries apply. */
3496 1.6 christos if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3497 1.3 christos {
3498 1.6 christos d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3499 1.1 skrll d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3500 1.3 christos d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3501 1.1 skrll }
3502 1.6 christos if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3503 1.3 christos {
3504 1.6 christos d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3505 1.1 skrll d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3506 1.1 skrll d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3507 1.1 skrll }
3508 1.1 skrll
3509 1.1 skrll /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3510 1.1 skrll if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3511 1.1 skrll {
3512 1.1 skrll s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3513 1.1 skrll if (s)
3514 1.1 skrll {
3515 1.1 skrll /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3516 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
3517 1.5 christos {
3518 1.1 skrll /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3519 1.1 skrll if (discarded_section (s))
3520 1.1 skrll {
3521 1.1 skrll asection *kept;
3522 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
3523 1.1 skrll (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3524 1.1 skrll abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3525 1.1 skrll s, s->owner);
3526 1.1 skrll /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3527 1.1 skrll size as the discarded one. */
3528 1.1 skrll kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3529 1.1 skrll if (kept == NULL)
3530 1.1 skrll {
3531 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3532 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3533 1.1 skrll }
3534 1.1 skrll s = kept;
3535 1.1 skrll }
3536 1.1 skrll
3537 1.1 skrll s = s->output_section;
3538 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3539 1.1 skrll }
3540 1.1 skrll else
3541 1.1 skrll {
3542 1.1 skrll /* Handle objcopy. */
3543 1.1 skrll if (s->output_section == NULL)
3544 1.1 skrll {
3545 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
3546 1.1 skrll (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3547 1.1 skrll abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3548 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3549 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3550 1.1 skrll }
3551 1.1 skrll s = s->output_section;
3552 1.1 skrll }
3553 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3554 1.1 skrll }
3555 1.1 skrll else
3556 1.1 skrll {
3557 1.1 skrll /* PR 290:
3558 1.1 skrll The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3559 1.1 skrll SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3560 1.1 skrll sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3561 1.1 skrll where s is NULL. */
3562 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3563 1.1 skrll = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3564 1.1 skrll if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3565 1.1 skrll bed->link_order_error_handler
3566 1.1 skrll (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3567 1.1 skrll abfd, sec);
3568 1.1 skrll }
3569 1.1 skrll }
3570 1.1 skrll
3571 1.1 skrll switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3572 1.1 skrll {
3573 1.1 skrll case SHT_REL:
3574 1.1 skrll case SHT_RELA:
3575 1.1 skrll /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3576 1.1 skrll section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3577 1.1 skrll table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3578 1.1 skrll which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3579 1.1 skrll allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3580 1.1 skrll FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3581 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3582 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3583 1.6 christos d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3584 1.1 skrll
3585 1.6 christos s = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->get_reloc_section (sec);
3586 1.6 christos if (s != NULL)
3587 1.6 christos {
3588 1.6 christos d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3589 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3590 1.1 skrll }
3591 1.1 skrll break;
3592 1.1 skrll
3593 1.1 skrll case SHT_STRTAB:
3594 1.1 skrll /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3595 1.1 skrll string section. We look for a section with the same name
3596 1.1 skrll but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3597 1.1 skrll field to point to this section. */
3598 1.1 skrll if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3599 1.1 skrll && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3600 1.1 skrll {
3601 1.1 skrll size_t len;
3602 1.1 skrll char *alc;
3603 1.3 christos
3604 1.1 skrll len = strlen (sec->name);
3605 1.1 skrll alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3606 1.1 skrll if (alc == NULL)
3607 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3608 1.1 skrll memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3609 1.1 skrll alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3610 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3611 1.1 skrll free (alc);
3612 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3613 1.1 skrll {
3614 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3615 1.1 skrll
3616 1.1 skrll /* This is a .stab section. */
3617 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3618 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3619 1.1 skrll = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3620 1.1 skrll }
3621 1.1 skrll }
3622 1.1 skrll break;
3623 1.1 skrll
3624 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3625 1.1 skrll case SHT_DYNSYM:
3626 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3627 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3628 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3629 1.1 skrll used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3630 1.1 skrll version strings. */
3631 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3632 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3633 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3634 1.1 skrll break;
3635 1.1 skrll
3636 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3637 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3638 1.1 skrll list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3639 1.1 skrll the version strings. */
3640 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3641 1.1 skrll ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3642 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3643 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3644 1.1 skrll break;
3645 1.1 skrll
3646 1.1 skrll case SHT_HASH:
3647 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3648 1.1 skrll case SHT_GNU_versym:
3649 1.1 skrll /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3650 1.1 skrll this hash table or version table is for. */
3651 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3652 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL)
3653 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3654 1.1 skrll break;
3655 1.6 christos
3656 1.1 skrll case SHT_GROUP:
3657 1.1 skrll d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3658 1.1 skrll }
3659 1.6 christos }
3660 1.6 christos
3661 1.6 christos /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3662 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3663 1.1 skrll debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3664 1.1 skrll
3665 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3666 1.1 skrll }
3667 1.1 skrll
3668 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3669 1.1 skrll sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3670 1.1 skrll {
3671 1.1 skrll /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3672 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3673 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3674 1.3 christos return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3675 1.1 skrll
3676 1.1 skrll return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3677 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3678 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3679 1.1 skrll }
3680 1.5 christos
3681 1.1 skrll /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
3682 1.1 skrll output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
3683 1.1 skrll
3684 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3685 1.5 christos ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3686 1.5 christos {
3687 1.5 christos elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
3688 1.5 christos
3689 1.5 christos if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
3690 1.5 christos return FALSE;
3691 1.5 christos
3692 1.5 christos type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
3693 1.5 christos return ((type_ptr != NULL
3694 1.5 christos && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
3695 1.1 skrll && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
3696 1.5 christos || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
3697 1.5 christos || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
3698 1.1 skrll && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
3699 1.1 skrll || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
3700 1.5 christos }
3701 1.5 christos
3702 1.5 christos /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
3703 1.1 skrll all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
3704 1.6 christos
3705 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
3706 1.1 skrll elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
3707 1.1 skrll {
3708 1.1 skrll unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
3709 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
3710 1.1 skrll asymbol **sect_syms;
3711 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_locals = 0;
3712 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_globals = 0;
3713 1.6 christos unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
3714 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
3715 1.1 skrll unsigned int max_index = 0;
3716 1.1 skrll unsigned int idx;
3717 1.1 skrll asection *asect;
3718 1.1 skrll asymbol **new_syms;
3719 1.1 skrll
3720 1.1 skrll #ifdef DEBUG
3721 1.1 skrll fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
3722 1.1 skrll fflush (stderr);
3723 1.1 skrll #endif
3724 1.1 skrll
3725 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3726 1.1 skrll {
3727 1.1 skrll if (max_index < asect->index)
3728 1.1 skrll max_index = asect->index;
3729 1.1 skrll }
3730 1.3 christos
3731 1.1 skrll max_index++;
3732 1.1 skrll sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
3733 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms == NULL)
3734 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3735 1.1 skrll elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
3736 1.1 skrll elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
3737 1.1 skrll
3738 1.1 skrll /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
3739 1.1 skrll decided to output. */
3740 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3741 1.1 skrll {
3742 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3743 1.1 skrll
3744 1.5 christos if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3745 1.5 christos && sym->value == 0
3746 1.1 skrll && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
3747 1.1 skrll && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
3748 1.1 skrll {
3749 1.1 skrll asection *sec = sym->section;
3750 1.1 skrll
3751 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner != abfd)
3752 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
3753 1.1 skrll
3754 1.1 skrll sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
3755 1.1 skrll }
3756 1.1 skrll }
3757 1.1 skrll
3758 1.1 skrll /* Classify all of the symbols. */
3759 1.5 christos for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3760 1.5 christos {
3761 1.5 christos if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
3762 1.1 skrll num_globals++;
3763 1.1 skrll else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
3764 1.1 skrll num_locals++;
3765 1.1 skrll }
3766 1.1 skrll
3767 1.1 skrll /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
3768 1.1 skrll sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
3769 1.1 skrll eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
3770 1.1 skrll at least in that case. */
3771 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3772 1.1 skrll {
3773 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3774 1.1 skrll {
3775 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
3776 1.1 skrll num_locals++;
3777 1.1 skrll else
3778 1.1 skrll num_globals++;
3779 1.1 skrll }
3780 1.1 skrll }
3781 1.3 christos
3782 1.3 christos /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
3783 1.1 skrll new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
3784 1.1 skrll sizeof (asymbol *));
3785 1.1 skrll
3786 1.1 skrll if (new_syms == NULL)
3787 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3788 1.1 skrll
3789 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3790 1.1 skrll {
3791 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3792 1.5 christos unsigned int i;
3793 1.5 christos
3794 1.5 christos if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3795 1.1 skrll i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3796 1.1 skrll else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3797 1.5 christos i = num_locals2++;
3798 1.1 skrll else
3799 1.1 skrll continue;
3800 1.1 skrll new_syms[i] = sym;
3801 1.1 skrll sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3802 1.1 skrll }
3803 1.1 skrll for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3804 1.1 skrll {
3805 1.1 skrll if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3806 1.1 skrll {
3807 1.1 skrll asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
3808 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
3809 1.1 skrll
3810 1.1 skrll sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
3811 1.1 skrll if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3812 1.1 skrll i = num_locals2++;
3813 1.1 skrll else
3814 1.1 skrll i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3815 1.1 skrll new_syms[i] = sym;
3816 1.1 skrll sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3817 1.1 skrll }
3818 1.1 skrll }
3819 1.1 skrll
3820 1.6 christos bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
3821 1.1 skrll
3822 1.1 skrll *pnum_locals = num_locals;
3823 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3824 1.1 skrll }
3825 1.1 skrll
3826 1.1 skrll /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
3827 1.1 skrll ELF data structure. */
3828 1.1 skrll
3829 1.1 skrll static inline file_ptr
3830 1.1 skrll align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
3831 1.1 skrll {
3832 1.1 skrll return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
3833 1.1 skrll }
3834 1.1 skrll
3835 1.1 skrll /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
3836 1.1 skrll required section alignment. */
3837 1.1 skrll
3838 1.1 skrll file_ptr
3839 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
3840 1.1 skrll file_ptr offset,
3841 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean align)
3842 1.1 skrll {
3843 1.1 skrll if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
3844 1.1 skrll offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
3845 1.1 skrll i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
3846 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
3847 1.1 skrll i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
3848 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
3849 1.1 skrll offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
3850 1.1 skrll return offset;
3851 1.1 skrll }
3852 1.1 skrll
3853 1.1 skrll /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
3854 1.1 skrll otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
3855 1.1 skrll is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
3856 1.1 skrll
3857 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
3858 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
3859 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3860 1.3 christos {
3861 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3862 1.6 christos struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
3863 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean failed;
3864 1.3 christos struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
3865 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
3866 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3867 1.1 skrll
3868 1.1 skrll if (abfd->output_has_begun)
3869 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3870 1.1 skrll
3871 1.1 skrll /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
3872 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
3873 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
3874 1.1 skrll
3875 1.1 skrll if (! prep_headers (abfd))
3876 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3877 1.6 christos
3878 1.1 skrll /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
3879 1.3 christos (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
3880 1.3 christos
3881 1.3 christos fsargs.failed = FALSE;
3882 1.3 christos fsargs.link_info = link_info;
3883 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
3884 1.1 skrll if (fsargs.failed)
3885 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3886 1.1 skrll
3887 1.1 skrll if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
3888 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3889 1.3 christos
3890 1.3 christos /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
3891 1.3 christos need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
3892 1.3 christos && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3893 1.3 christos || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3894 1.1 skrll == HAS_RELOC)));
3895 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
3896 1.1 skrll {
3897 1.1 skrll /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
3898 1.1 skrll int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
3899 1.1 skrll
3900 1.1 skrll if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
3901 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3902 1.3 christos }
3903 1.1 skrll
3904 1.1 skrll failed = FALSE;
3905 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL)
3906 1.1 skrll {
3907 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
3908 1.1 skrll if (failed)
3909 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3910 1.1 skrll }
3911 1.1 skrll
3912 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
3913 1.1 skrll /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
3914 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
3915 1.6 christos shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3916 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3917 1.1 skrll /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3918 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3919 1.6 christos shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3920 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
3921 1.1 skrll /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3922 1.1 skrll shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
3923 1.1 skrll
3924 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
3925 1.3 christos return FALSE;
3926 1.1 skrll
3927 1.1 skrll if (need_symtab)
3928 1.1 skrll {
3929 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
3930 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
3931 1.1 skrll
3932 1.6 christos off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
3933 1.1 skrll
3934 1.1 skrll hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
3935 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3936 1.6 christos
3937 1.6 christos if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
3938 1.6 christos {
3939 1.6 christos hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
3940 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
3941 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3942 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
3943 1.1 skrll }
3944 1.1 skrll
3945 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
3946 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3947 1.1 skrll
3948 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
3949 1.1 skrll
3950 1.1 skrll /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
3951 1.6 christos out. */
3952 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
3953 1.6 christos || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
3954 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
3955 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
3956 1.1 skrll }
3957 1.1 skrll
3958 1.1 skrll abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
3959 1.1 skrll
3960 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
3961 1.1 skrll }
3962 1.1 skrll
3963 1.1 skrll /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
3964 1.1 skrll get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
3965 1.1 skrll
3966 1.1 skrll static bfd_size_type
3967 1.1 skrll get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3968 1.1 skrll {
3969 1.1 skrll size_t segs;
3970 1.1 skrll asection *s;
3971 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3972 1.1 skrll
3973 1.1 skrll /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
3974 1.1 skrll and one for data. */
3975 1.1 skrll segs = 2;
3976 1.1 skrll
3977 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3978 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3979 1.1 skrll {
3980 1.1 skrll /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
3981 1.1 skrll PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
3982 1.1 skrll PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
3983 1.1 skrll targets. */
3984 1.1 skrll segs += 2;
3985 1.1 skrll }
3986 1.1 skrll
3987 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
3988 1.1 skrll {
3989 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
3990 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3991 1.1 skrll }
3992 1.1 skrll
3993 1.1 skrll if (info != NULL && info->relro)
3994 1.1 skrll {
3995 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
3996 1.1 skrll ++segs;
3997 1.6 christos }
3998 1.1 skrll
3999 1.1 skrll if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4000 1.1 skrll {
4001 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4002 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4003 1.6 christos }
4004 1.1 skrll
4005 1.1 skrll if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4006 1.1 skrll {
4007 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4008 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4009 1.1 skrll }
4010 1.1 skrll
4011 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4012 1.1 skrll {
4013 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4014 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4015 1.1 skrll {
4016 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4017 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4018 1.1 skrll /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4019 1.1 skrll for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4020 1.1 skrll gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4021 1.1 skrll (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4022 1.1 skrll each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4023 1.1 skrll so we check whether the sections are correctly
4024 1.1 skrll aligned. */
4025 1.1 skrll if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4026 1.1 skrll while (s->next != NULL
4027 1.1 skrll && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4028 1.1 skrll && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4029 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4030 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
4031 1.1 skrll }
4032 1.1 skrll }
4033 1.1 skrll
4034 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4035 1.1 skrll {
4036 1.1 skrll if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4037 1.1 skrll {
4038 1.1 skrll /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4039 1.1 skrll ++segs;
4040 1.1 skrll break;
4041 1.1 skrll }
4042 1.1 skrll }
4043 1.1 skrll
4044 1.1 skrll /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4045 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4046 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4047 1.1 skrll {
4048 1.1 skrll int a;
4049 1.1 skrll
4050 1.1 skrll a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4051 1.1 skrll if (a == -1)
4052 1.1 skrll abort ();
4053 1.1 skrll segs += a;
4054 1.1 skrll }
4055 1.1 skrll
4056 1.1 skrll return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4057 1.1 skrll }
4058 1.1 skrll
4059 1.1 skrll /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4060 1.1 skrll
4061 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4062 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4063 1.1 skrll {
4064 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4065 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4066 1.1 skrll
4067 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4068 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
4069 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++)
4070 1.1 skrll {
4071 1.1 skrll int i;
4072 1.1 skrll
4073 1.1 skrll for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4074 1.1 skrll if (m->sections[i] == section)
4075 1.1 skrll return p;
4076 1.1 skrll }
4077 1.1 skrll
4078 1.1 skrll return NULL;
4079 1.1 skrll }
4080 1.1 skrll
4081 1.1 skrll /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4082 1.1 skrll
4083 1.1 skrll static struct elf_segment_map *
4084 1.1 skrll make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4085 1.1 skrll asection **sections,
4086 1.1 skrll unsigned int from,
4087 1.1 skrll unsigned int to,
4088 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr)
4089 1.1 skrll {
4090 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4091 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
4092 1.1 skrll asection **hdrpp;
4093 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
4094 1.1 skrll
4095 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4096 1.1 skrll amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4097 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4098 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4099 1.1 skrll return NULL;
4100 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4101 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4102 1.1 skrll for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4103 1.1 skrll m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4104 1.1 skrll m->count = to - from;
4105 1.1 skrll
4106 1.1 skrll if (from == 0 && phdr)
4107 1.1 skrll {
4108 1.1 skrll /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4109 1.1 skrll m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4110 1.1 skrll m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4111 1.1 skrll }
4112 1.1 skrll
4113 1.1 skrll return m;
4114 1.1 skrll }
4115 1.1 skrll
4116 1.1 skrll /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4117 1.1 skrll on failure. */
4118 1.1 skrll
4119 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *
4120 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4121 1.1 skrll {
4122 1.3 christos struct elf_segment_map *m;
4123 1.3 christos
4124 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4125 1.1 skrll sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4126 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4127 1.1 skrll return NULL;
4128 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4129 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4130 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
4131 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4132 1.1 skrll
4133 1.1 skrll return m;
4134 1.1 skrll }
4135 1.1 skrll
4136 1.1 skrll /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4137 1.1 skrll
4138 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4139 1.1 skrll elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4140 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *info,
4141 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4142 1.1 skrll {
4143 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **m;
4144 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4145 1.1 skrll
4146 1.1 skrll /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4147 1.1 skrll not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4148 1.1 skrll sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4149 1.6 christos sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4150 1.1 skrll removed. */
4151 1.1 skrll m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4152 1.1 skrll while (*m)
4153 1.1 skrll {
4154 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, new_count;
4155 1.1 skrll
4156 1.1 skrll for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4157 1.1 skrll {
4158 1.1 skrll if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4159 1.1 skrll && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4160 1.1 skrll || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4161 1.1 skrll {
4162 1.1 skrll (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4163 1.1 skrll new_count++;
4164 1.1 skrll }
4165 1.1 skrll }
4166 1.1 skrll (*m)->count = new_count;
4167 1.1 skrll
4168 1.1 skrll if (remove_empty_load && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
4169 1.1 skrll *m = (*m)->next;
4170 1.1 skrll else
4171 1.1 skrll m = &(*m)->next;
4172 1.1 skrll }
4173 1.1 skrll
4174 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4175 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4176 1.1 skrll {
4177 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4178 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4179 1.1 skrll }
4180 1.1 skrll
4181 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4182 1.1 skrll }
4183 1.1 skrll
4184 1.1 skrll /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4185 1.1 skrll
4186 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
4187 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4188 1.1 skrll {
4189 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
4190 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4191 1.1 skrll asection **sections = NULL;
4192 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4193 1.6 christos bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4194 1.5 christos
4195 1.5 christos no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4196 1.5 christos
4197 1.5 christos if (info != NULL)
4198 1.1 skrll info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4199 1.1 skrll
4200 1.1 skrll if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4201 1.1 skrll {
4202 1.1 skrll asection *s;
4203 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
4204 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4205 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4206 1.1 skrll asection *last_hdr;
4207 1.1 skrll bfd_vma last_size;
4208 1.1 skrll unsigned int phdr_index;
4209 1.1 skrll bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4210 1.1 skrll asection **hdrpp;
4211 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4212 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean writable;
4213 1.1 skrll int tls_count = 0;
4214 1.1 skrll asection *first_tls = NULL;
4215 1.3 christos asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4216 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
4217 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4218 1.1 skrll
4219 1.3 christos /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4220 1.3 christos
4221 1.1 skrll sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4222 1.1 skrll sizeof (asection *));
4223 1.1 skrll if (sections == NULL)
4224 1.3 christos goto error_return;
4225 1.3 christos
4226 1.3 christos /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4227 1.3 christos left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4228 1.3 christos being shifted. */
4229 1.3 christos addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4230 1.1 skrll addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4231 1.1 skrll
4232 1.1 skrll i = 0;
4233 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4234 1.1 skrll {
4235 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4236 1.1 skrll {
4237 1.3 christos sections[i] = s;
4238 1.3 christos ++i;
4239 1.3 christos /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4240 1.1 skrll if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4241 1.1 skrll wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4242 1.1 skrll }
4243 1.1 skrll }
4244 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4245 1.1 skrll count = i;
4246 1.1 skrll
4247 1.1 skrll qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4248 1.1 skrll
4249 1.1 skrll /* Build the mapping. */
4250 1.1 skrll
4251 1.1 skrll mfirst = NULL;
4252 1.1 skrll pm = &mfirst;
4253 1.1 skrll
4254 1.1 skrll /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4255 1.1 skrll the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4256 1.1 skrll section. */
4257 1.1 skrll s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4258 1.1 skrll if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4259 1.3 christos {
4260 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4261 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4262 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4263 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4264 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4265 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4266 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not. */
4267 1.1 skrll m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
4268 1.1 skrll m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4269 1.1 skrll m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4270 1.1 skrll
4271 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4272 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4273 1.3 christos
4274 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4275 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4276 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4277 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4278 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4279 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4280 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
4281 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = s;
4282 1.1 skrll
4283 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4284 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4285 1.1 skrll }
4286 1.1 skrll
4287 1.1 skrll /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4288 1.1 skrll segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4289 1.1 skrll a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4290 1.1 skrll last_hdr = NULL;
4291 1.1 skrll last_size = 0;
4292 1.6 christos phdr_index = 0;
4293 1.6 christos maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4294 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4295 1.6 christos Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4296 1.6 christos FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4297 1.1 skrll if (maxpagesize == 0)
4298 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = 1;
4299 1.1 skrll writable = FALSE;
4300 1.1 skrll dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4301 1.1 skrll if (dynsec != NULL
4302 1.1 skrll && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4303 1.1 skrll dynsec = NULL;
4304 1.1 skrll
4305 1.1 skrll /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4306 1.1 skrll is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4307 1.1 skrll approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4308 1.1 skrll program headers we will need. */
4309 1.6 christos if (count > 0)
4310 1.1 skrll {
4311 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4312 1.1 skrll
4313 1.5 christos if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4314 1.1 skrll phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4315 1.3 christos phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4316 1.3 christos if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4317 1.3 christos || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4318 1.3 christos || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4319 1.1 skrll < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4320 1.1 skrll || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4321 1.1 skrll phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4322 1.1 skrll }
4323 1.1 skrll
4324 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4325 1.1 skrll {
4326 1.1 skrll asection *hdr;
4327 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean new_segment;
4328 1.1 skrll
4329 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
4330 1.1 skrll
4331 1.1 skrll /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4332 1.1 skrll segment. */
4333 1.1 skrll
4334 1.1 skrll if (last_hdr == NULL)
4335 1.1 skrll {
4336 1.1 skrll /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4337 1.1 skrll one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4338 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
4339 1.1 skrll }
4340 1.1 skrll else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4341 1.1 skrll {
4342 1.1 skrll /* If this section has a different relation between the
4343 1.1 skrll virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4344 1.1 skrll segment. */
4345 1.3 christos new_segment = TRUE;
4346 1.3 christos }
4347 1.3 christos else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4348 1.3 christos || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4349 1.3 christos {
4350 1.3 christos /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4351 1.3 christos the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4352 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4353 1.1 skrll }
4354 1.1 skrll /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4355 1.1 skrll to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4356 1.1 skrll around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4357 1.1 skrll pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4358 1.1 skrll section can be included in the current segment. */
4359 1.1 skrll else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4360 1.1 skrll > last_hdr->lma)
4361 1.1 skrll && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4362 1.1 skrll <= hdr->lma))
4363 1.1 skrll {
4364 1.1 skrll /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4365 1.1 skrll skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4366 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4367 1.6 christos }
4368 1.6 christos else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4369 1.6 christos && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0
4370 1.6 christos && ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4371 1.6 christos || (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4372 1.6 christos != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize))))
4373 1.6 christos {
4374 1.6 christos /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4375 1.6 christos nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4376 1.6 christos as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4377 1.6 christos Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose.
4378 1.6 christos However, like the writable/non-writable case below,
4379 1.1 skrll if they are on the same page then they must be put
4380 1.1 skrll in the same segment. */
4381 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4382 1.1 skrll }
4383 1.1 skrll else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4384 1.1 skrll {
4385 1.1 skrll /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4386 1.1 skrll don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4387 1.1 skrll file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4388 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
4389 1.1 skrll }
4390 1.3 christos else if (! writable
4391 1.3 christos && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
4392 1.1 skrll && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4393 1.1 skrll != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4394 1.1 skrll {
4395 1.1 skrll /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4396 1.1 skrll segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
4397 1.1 skrll anyhow. We already know that the last section does not
4398 1.1 skrll bring us past the current section on the page, so the
4399 1.1 skrll only case in which the new section is not on the same
4400 1.1 skrll page as the previous section is when the previous section
4401 1.1 skrll ends precisely on a page boundary. */
4402 1.1 skrll new_segment = TRUE;
4403 1.1 skrll }
4404 1.1 skrll else
4405 1.1 skrll {
4406 1.1 skrll /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4407 1.1 skrll new_segment = FALSE;
4408 1.1 skrll }
4409 1.1 skrll
4410 1.1 skrll /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4411 1.1 skrll if (last_hdr != NULL
4412 1.1 skrll && info != NULL
4413 1.1 skrll && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4414 1.1 skrll new_segment
4415 1.1 skrll = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4416 1.1 skrll last_hdr,
4417 1.1 skrll new_segment);
4418 1.1 skrll
4419 1.1 skrll if (! new_segment)
4420 1.1 skrll {
4421 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4422 1.1 skrll writable = TRUE;
4423 1.1 skrll last_hdr = hdr;
4424 1.1 skrll /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4425 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4426 1.1 skrll != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4427 1.1 skrll last_size = hdr->size;
4428 1.1 skrll else
4429 1.1 skrll last_size = 0;
4430 1.1 skrll continue;
4431 1.1 skrll }
4432 1.1 skrll
4433 1.1 skrll /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4434 1.1 skrll header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4435 1.1 skrll
4436 1.1 skrll m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4437 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4438 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4439 1.1 skrll
4440 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4441 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4442 1.1 skrll
4443 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4444 1.1 skrll writable = TRUE;
4445 1.1 skrll else
4446 1.1 skrll writable = FALSE;
4447 1.1 skrll
4448 1.1 skrll last_hdr = hdr;
4449 1.1 skrll /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4450 1.1 skrll if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4451 1.1 skrll last_size = hdr->size;
4452 1.1 skrll else
4453 1.1 skrll last_size = 0;
4454 1.1 skrll phdr_index = i;
4455 1.1 skrll phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4456 1.3 christos }
4457 1.3 christos
4458 1.3 christos /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4459 1.3 christos for .tbss. */
4460 1.3 christos if (last_hdr != NULL
4461 1.3 christos && (i - phdr_index != 1
4462 1.1 skrll || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4463 1.1 skrll != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
4464 1.1 skrll {
4465 1.1 skrll m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4466 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4467 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4468 1.1 skrll
4469 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4470 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4471 1.1 skrll }
4472 1.1 skrll
4473 1.1 skrll /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4474 1.1 skrll if (dynsec != NULL)
4475 1.1 skrll {
4476 1.1 skrll m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4477 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4478 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4479 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4480 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4481 1.1 skrll }
4482 1.1 skrll
4483 1.1 skrll /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4484 1.1 skrll add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4485 1.1 skrll because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4486 1.1 skrll loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4487 1.1 skrll in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4488 1.1 skrll bogus anyhow. */
4489 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4490 1.1 skrll {
4491 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4492 1.1 skrll && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4493 1.3 christos {
4494 1.3 christos asection *s2;
4495 1.1 skrll
4496 1.1 skrll count = 1;
4497 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4498 1.1 skrll if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4499 1.1 skrll for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4500 1.1 skrll {
4501 1.1 skrll if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4502 1.3 christos && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4503 1.3 christos && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4504 1.1 skrll && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4505 1.1 skrll == s2->next->lma)
4506 1.1 skrll count++;
4507 1.1 skrll else
4508 1.1 skrll break;
4509 1.3 christos }
4510 1.1 skrll amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4511 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4512 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4513 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4514 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4515 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4516 1.1 skrll m->count = count;
4517 1.1 skrll while (count > 1)
4518 1.1 skrll {
4519 1.1 skrll m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4520 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4521 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
4522 1.1 skrll }
4523 1.1 skrll m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4524 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4525 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4526 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4527 1.1 skrll }
4528 1.1 skrll if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4529 1.1 skrll {
4530 1.1 skrll if (! tls_count)
4531 1.1 skrll first_tls = s;
4532 1.1 skrll tls_count++;
4533 1.1 skrll }
4534 1.1 skrll }
4535 1.1 skrll
4536 1.1 skrll /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4537 1.1 skrll if (tls_count > 0)
4538 1.1 skrll {
4539 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4540 1.1 skrll amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4541 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4542 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4543 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4544 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4545 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4546 1.1 skrll m->count = tls_count;
4547 1.1 skrll /* Mandated PF_R. */
4548 1.6 christos m->p_flags = PF_R;
4549 1.3 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4550 1.1 skrll s = first_tls;
4551 1.6 christos for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4552 1.6 christos {
4553 1.6 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4554 1.6 christos {
4555 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler
4556 1.6 christos (_("%B: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4557 1.6 christos s = first_tls;
4558 1.6 christos i = 0;
4559 1.6 christos while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4560 1.6 christos {
4561 1.6 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4562 1.6 christos {
4563 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %A"), s);
4564 1.6 christos i++;
4565 1.6 christos }
4566 1.6 christos else
4567 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %A"), s);
4568 1.6 christos s = s->next;
4569 1.6 christos }
4570 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4571 1.6 christos goto error_return;
4572 1.6 christos }
4573 1.1 skrll m->sections[i] = s;
4574 1.1 skrll s = s->next;
4575 1.1 skrll }
4576 1.1 skrll
4577 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4578 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4579 1.1 skrll }
4580 1.1 skrll
4581 1.6 christos /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4582 1.1 skrll segment. */
4583 1.1 skrll eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
4584 1.1 skrll if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4585 1.1 skrll && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4586 1.3 christos {
4587 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4588 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4589 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4590 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4591 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4592 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4593 1.1 skrll m->count = 1;
4594 1.1 skrll m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4595 1.1 skrll
4596 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4597 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4598 1.6 christos }
4599 1.1 skrll
4600 1.1 skrll if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4601 1.3 christos {
4602 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4603 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4604 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4605 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4606 1.6 christos m->next = NULL;
4607 1.6 christos m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4608 1.1 skrll m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
4609 1.6 christos m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
4610 1.6 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4611 1.6 christos m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
4612 1.6 christos if (info->stacksize > 0)
4613 1.6 christos {
4614 1.6 christos m->p_size = info->stacksize;
4615 1.1 skrll m->p_size_valid = 1;
4616 1.1 skrll }
4617 1.1 skrll
4618 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4619 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4620 1.1 skrll }
4621 1.1 skrll
4622 1.1 skrll if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4623 1.1 skrll {
4624 1.5 christos for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4625 1.5 christos {
4626 1.5 christos if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
4627 1.5 christos && m->count != 0
4628 1.5 christos && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
4629 1.5 christos && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
4630 1.5 christos {
4631 1.5 christos i = m->count;
4632 1.5 christos while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
4633 1.5 christos if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4634 1.5 christos == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4635 1.6 christos break;
4636 1.1 skrll
4637 1.1 skrll if (i != (unsigned) -1)
4638 1.5 christos break;
4639 1.1 skrll }
4640 1.1 skrll }
4641 1.1 skrll
4642 1.1 skrll /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
4643 1.1 skrll if (m != NULL)
4644 1.3 christos {
4645 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4646 1.1 skrll m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4647 1.1 skrll if (m == NULL)
4648 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
4649 1.1 skrll m->next = NULL;
4650 1.1 skrll m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
4651 1.1 skrll *pm = m;
4652 1.1 skrll pm = &m->next;
4653 1.1 skrll }
4654 1.1 skrll }
4655 1.6 christos
4656 1.1 skrll free (sections);
4657 1.1 skrll elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
4658 1.1 skrll }
4659 1.1 skrll
4660 1.1 skrll if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
4661 1.6 christos return FALSE;
4662 1.1 skrll
4663 1.6 christos for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
4664 1.1 skrll ++count;
4665 1.1 skrll elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4666 1.1 skrll
4667 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4668 1.1 skrll
4669 1.1 skrll error_return:
4670 1.1 skrll if (sections != NULL)
4671 1.1 skrll free (sections);
4672 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4673 1.1 skrll }
4674 1.1 skrll
4675 1.1 skrll /* Sort sections by address. */
4676 1.1 skrll
4677 1.1 skrll static int
4678 1.1 skrll elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
4679 1.1 skrll {
4680 1.1 skrll const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
4681 1.1 skrll const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
4682 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type size1, size2;
4683 1.1 skrll
4684 1.1 skrll /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
4685 1.1 skrll place the section into a segment. */
4686 1.1 skrll if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
4687 1.1 skrll return -1;
4688 1.1 skrll else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
4689 1.1 skrll return 1;
4690 1.1 skrll
4691 1.1 skrll /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
4692 1.1 skrll the same, and this will do nothing. */
4693 1.1 skrll if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
4694 1.1 skrll return -1;
4695 1.1 skrll else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
4696 1.1 skrll return 1;
4697 1.1 skrll
4698 1.1 skrll /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
4699 1.1 skrll
4700 1.1 skrll #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
4701 1.1 skrll
4702 1.1 skrll if (TOEND (sec1))
4703 1.1 skrll {
4704 1.1 skrll if (TOEND (sec2))
4705 1.1 skrll {
4706 1.1 skrll /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
4707 1.1 skrll here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
4708 1.1 skrll if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
4709 1.1 skrll return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4710 1.1 skrll }
4711 1.1 skrll else
4712 1.1 skrll return 1;
4713 1.1 skrll }
4714 1.1 skrll else if (TOEND (sec2))
4715 1.1 skrll return -1;
4716 1.1 skrll
4717 1.1 skrll #undef TOEND
4718 1.1 skrll
4719 1.1 skrll /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
4720 1.1 skrll before others at the same address. */
4721 1.1 skrll
4722 1.1 skrll size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
4723 1.1 skrll size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
4724 1.1 skrll
4725 1.1 skrll if (size1 < size2)
4726 1.1 skrll return -1;
4727 1.1 skrll if (size1 > size2)
4728 1.1 skrll return 1;
4729 1.1 skrll
4730 1.1 skrll return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4731 1.1 skrll }
4732 1.1 skrll
4733 1.1 skrll /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
4734 1.1 skrll
4735 1.1 skrll We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
4736 1.1 skrll not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
4737 1.1 skrll negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
4738 1.1 skrll are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
4739 1.1 skrll larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
4740 1.1 skrll which is wrong.
4741 1.1 skrll
4742 1.1 skrll What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
4743 1.1 skrll the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
4744 1.1 skrll the page size.'' */
4745 1.1 skrll /* In other words, something like:
4746 1.1 skrll
4747 1.1 skrll vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
4748 1.1 skrll off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
4749 1.1 skrll if (vma_offset < off_offset)
4750 1.1 skrll adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
4751 1.1 skrll else
4752 1.1 skrll adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
4753 1.1 skrll
4754 1.1 skrll which can can be collapsed into the expression below. */
4755 1.1 skrll
4756 1.1 skrll static file_ptr
4757 1.6 christos vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
4758 1.6 christos {
4759 1.6 christos /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
4760 1.1 skrll if (maxpagesize == 0)
4761 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = 1;
4762 1.1 skrll return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
4763 1.1 skrll }
4764 1.1 skrll
4765 1.1 skrll static void
4766 1.1 skrll print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
4767 1.1 skrll {
4768 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
4769 1.1 skrll const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
4770 1.1 skrll char buf[32];
4771 1.1 skrll
4772 1.1 skrll if (pt == NULL)
4773 1.1 skrll {
4774 1.1 skrll if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
4775 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
4776 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
4777 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
4778 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
4779 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
4780 1.1 skrll else
4781 1.1 skrll snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
4782 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) m->p_type);
4783 1.3 christos pt = buf;
4784 1.1 skrll }
4785 1.1 skrll fflush (stdout);
4786 1.1 skrll fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
4787 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
4788 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
4789 1.3 christos putc ('\n',stderr);
4790 1.3 christos fflush (stderr);
4791 1.3 christos }
4792 1.3 christos
4793 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
4794 1.3 christos write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
4795 1.3 christos {
4796 1.3 christos void *buf;
4797 1.3 christos bfd_boolean ret;
4798 1.3 christos
4799 1.3 christos if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
4800 1.3 christos return FALSE;
4801 1.3 christos buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
4802 1.3 christos if (buf == NULL)
4803 1.3 christos return FALSE;
4804 1.3 christos ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
4805 1.1 skrll free (buf);
4806 1.1 skrll return ret;
4807 1.1 skrll }
4808 1.1 skrll
4809 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
4810 1.1 skrll sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
4811 1.1 skrll the file header. */
4812 1.1 skrll
4813 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
4814 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4815 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4816 1.1 skrll {
4817 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4818 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
4819 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4820 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4821 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
4822 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
4823 1.2 skrll unsigned int alloc;
4824 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, j;
4825 1.1 skrll bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
4826 1.1 skrll
4827 1.1 skrll if (link_info == NULL
4828 1.1 skrll && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
4829 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4830 1.6 christos
4831 1.2 skrll alloc = 0;
4832 1.2 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
4833 1.2 skrll {
4834 1.2 skrll ++alloc;
4835 1.2 skrll if (m->header_size)
4836 1.1 skrll header_pad = m->header_size;
4837 1.5 christos }
4838 1.5 christos
4839 1.5 christos if (alloc)
4840 1.5 christos {
4841 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4842 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4843 1.5 christos }
4844 1.5 christos else
4845 1.5 christos {
4846 1.5 christos /* PR binutils/12467. */
4847 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
4848 1.5 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
4849 1.1 skrll }
4850 1.1 skrll
4851 1.6 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
4852 1.6 christos
4853 1.1 skrll if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4854 1.6 christos elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4855 1.1 skrll else
4856 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
4857 1.1 skrll >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
4858 1.1 skrll
4859 1.6 christos if (alloc == 0)
4860 1.1 skrll {
4861 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4862 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
4863 1.6 christos }
4864 1.2 skrll
4865 1.2 skrll /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
4866 1.6 christos see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
4867 1.6 christos that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
4868 1.2 skrll The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
4869 1.2 skrll elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
4870 1.2 skrll layout.
4871 1.2 skrll See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
4872 1.6 christos where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
4873 1.2 skrll last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
4874 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
4875 1.3 christos == 0);
4876 1.6 christos phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
4877 1.3 christos bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
4878 1.1 skrll (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
4879 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
4880 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
4881 1.1 skrll if (phdrs == NULL)
4882 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
4883 1.1 skrll
4884 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = 1;
4885 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4886 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4887 1.1 skrll
4888 1.2 skrll off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4889 1.2 skrll off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4890 1.2 skrll if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
4891 1.2 skrll header_pad = 0;
4892 1.2 skrll else
4893 1.1 skrll header_pad -= off;
4894 1.6 christos off += header_pad;
4895 1.1 skrll
4896 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
4897 1.1 skrll m != NULL;
4898 1.1 skrll m = m->next, p++, j++)
4899 1.1 skrll {
4900 1.1 skrll asection **secpp;
4901 1.1 skrll bfd_vma off_adjust;
4902 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean no_contents;
4903 1.1 skrll
4904 1.1 skrll /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
4905 1.1 skrll sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
4906 1.1 skrll not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
4907 1.1 skrll contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
4908 1.1 skrll Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
4909 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 1
4910 1.1 skrll && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
4911 1.1 skrll && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
4912 1.1 skrll qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
4913 1.1 skrll elf_sort_sections);
4914 1.1 skrll
4915 1.1 skrll /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
4916 1.1 skrll number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
4917 1.1 skrll and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
4918 1.1 skrll that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
4919 1.1 skrll available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
4920 1.1 skrll p->p_type = m->p_type;
4921 1.1 skrll p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
4922 1.1 skrll
4923 1.1 skrll if (m->count == 0)
4924 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = 0;
4925 1.1 skrll else
4926 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4927 1.1 skrll
4928 1.1 skrll if (m->p_paddr_valid)
4929 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
4930 1.1 skrll else if (m->count == 0)
4931 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = 0;
4932 1.1 skrll else
4933 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4934 1.1 skrll
4935 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4936 1.1 skrll && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4937 1.1 skrll {
4938 1.1 skrll /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
4939 1.1 skrll the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
4940 1.1 skrll objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
4941 1.1 skrll value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
4942 1.1 skrll may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
4943 1.1 skrll segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
4944 1.1 skrll on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
4945 1.1 skrll segment. */
4946 1.1 skrll if (m->p_align_valid)
4947 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = m->p_align;
4948 1.1 skrll
4949 1.1 skrll p->p_align = maxpagesize;
4950 1.1 skrll }
4951 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_align_valid)
4952 1.1 skrll p->p_align = m->p_align;
4953 1.1 skrll else if (m->count == 0)
4954 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
4955 1.1 skrll else
4956 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 0;
4957 1.1 skrll
4958 1.1 skrll no_contents = FALSE;
4959 1.1 skrll off_adjust = 0;
4960 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4961 1.1 skrll && m->count > 0)
4962 1.1 skrll {
4963 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type align;
4964 1.1 skrll unsigned int align_power = 0;
4965 1.1 skrll
4966 1.1 skrll if (m->p_align_valid)
4967 1.1 skrll align = p->p_align;
4968 1.1 skrll else
4969 1.1 skrll {
4970 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4971 1.1 skrll {
4972 1.1 skrll unsigned int secalign;
4973 1.1 skrll
4974 1.1 skrll secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
4975 1.1 skrll if (secalign > align_power)
4976 1.1 skrll align_power = secalign;
4977 1.1 skrll }
4978 1.1 skrll align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
4979 1.1 skrll if (align < maxpagesize)
4980 1.1 skrll align = maxpagesize;
4981 1.1 skrll }
4982 1.1 skrll
4983 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4984 1.1 skrll if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
4985 1.1 skrll /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
4986 1.1 skrll it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
4987 1.1 skrll set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
4988 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
4989 1.1 skrll
4990 1.1 skrll /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
4991 1.1 skrll sections. */
4992 1.1 skrll no_contents = TRUE;
4993 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4994 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
4995 1.1 skrll {
4996 1.1 skrll no_contents = FALSE;
4997 1.1 skrll break;
4998 1.3 christos }
4999 1.1 skrll
5000 1.1 skrll off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5001 1.1 skrll off += off_adjust;
5002 1.1 skrll if (no_contents)
5003 1.1 skrll {
5004 1.1 skrll /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5005 1.1 skrll the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5006 1.1 skrll arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5007 1.1 skrll checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5008 1.1 skrll requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5009 1.1 skrll p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5010 1.1 skrll subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5011 1.1 skrll past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5012 1.1 skrll }
5013 1.1 skrll else
5014 1.1 skrll off_adjust = 0;
5015 1.1 skrll }
5016 1.1 skrll /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5017 1.1 skrll PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5018 1.1 skrll else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5019 1.1 skrll && m->count > 1
5020 1.1 skrll && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5021 1.1 skrll {
5022 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler
5023 1.1 skrll (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
5024 1.1 skrll abfd);
5025 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5026 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5027 1.1 skrll }
5028 1.1 skrll /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5029 1.1 skrll else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5030 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5031 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5032 1.1 skrll
5033 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = 0;
5034 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = 0;
5035 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = 0;
5036 1.1 skrll
5037 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_filehdr)
5038 1.1 skrll {
5039 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5040 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5041 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5042 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5043 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 0)
5044 1.1 skrll {
5045 1.1 skrll if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
5046 1.1 skrll {
5047 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
5048 1.1 skrll (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
5049 1.1 skrll abfd);
5050 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5051 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5052 1.1 skrll }
5053 1.1 skrll
5054 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr -= off;
5055 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5056 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr -= off;
5057 1.1 skrll }
5058 1.1 skrll }
5059 1.1 skrll
5060 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_phdrs)
5061 1.1 skrll {
5062 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5063 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5064 1.1 skrll
5065 1.1 skrll if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5066 1.1 skrll {
5067 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5068 1.1 skrll
5069 1.1 skrll if (m->count > 0)
5070 1.1 skrll {
5071 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5072 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5073 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5074 1.1 skrll }
5075 1.1 skrll }
5076 1.1 skrll
5077 1.2 skrll p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5078 1.2 skrll p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5079 1.2 skrll if (m->count)
5080 1.2 skrll {
5081 1.2 skrll p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5082 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5083 1.1 skrll }
5084 1.1 skrll }
5085 1.1 skrll
5086 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5087 1.1 skrll || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5088 1.1 skrll {
5089 1.1 skrll if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5090 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = off;
5091 1.1 skrll else
5092 1.1 skrll {
5093 1.1 skrll file_ptr adjust;
5094 1.1 skrll
5095 1.1 skrll adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5096 1.1 skrll if (!no_contents)
5097 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += adjust;
5098 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += adjust;
5099 1.1 skrll }
5100 1.1 skrll }
5101 1.1 skrll
5102 1.1 skrll /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5103 1.1 skrll maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5104 1.1 skrll core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5105 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5106 1.1 skrll for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5107 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5108 1.1 skrll {
5109 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
5110 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type align;
5111 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5112 1.1 skrll
5113 1.1 skrll sec = *secpp;
5114 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5115 1.1 skrll align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5116 1.1 skrll
5117 1.1 skrll if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5118 1.1 skrll || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5119 1.1 skrll && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5120 1.1 skrll || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5121 1.1 skrll && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5122 1.3 christos || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5123 1.3 christos {
5124 1.3 christos bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5125 1.3 christos bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5126 1.3 christos bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5127 1.3 christos bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5128 1.3 christos
5129 1.3 christos if (adjust != 0
5130 1.1 skrll && (s_start < p_end
5131 1.1 skrll || p_end < p_start))
5132 1.3 christos {
5133 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
5134 1.1 skrll (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
5135 1.3 christos (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
5136 1.1 skrll adjust = 0;
5137 1.1 skrll sec->lma = p_end;
5138 1.1 skrll }
5139 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += adjust;
5140 1.1 skrll
5141 1.3 christos if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5142 1.3 christos {
5143 1.3 christos if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5144 1.3 christos {
5145 1.3 christos /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5146 1.3 christos Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5147 1.3 christos zero it. */
5148 1.3 christos adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5149 1.3 christos if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5150 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5151 1.1 skrll }
5152 1.1 skrll off += adjust;
5153 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += adjust;
5154 1.1 skrll }
5155 1.1 skrll }
5156 1.1 skrll
5157 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5158 1.1 skrll {
5159 1.1 skrll /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5160 1.1 skrll everything. */
5161 1.1 skrll if (i == 0)
5162 1.1 skrll {
5163 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5164 1.1 skrll off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5165 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5166 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = 0;
5167 1.1 skrll p->p_align = 1;
5168 1.1 skrll }
5169 1.1 skrll else
5170 1.1 skrll {
5171 1.1 skrll /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5172 1.1 skrll sec->filepos = 0;
5173 1.1 skrll sec->size = 0;
5174 1.1 skrll sec->flags = 0;
5175 1.1 skrll continue;
5176 1.1 skrll }
5177 1.1 skrll }
5178 1.1 skrll else
5179 1.1 skrll {
5180 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5181 1.1 skrll {
5182 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5183 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5184 1.3 christos off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5185 1.3 christos }
5186 1.3 christos else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5187 1.3 christos && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5188 1.3 christos && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5189 1.3 christos {
5190 1.3 christos /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5191 1.3 christos (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5192 1.3 christos final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5193 1.3 christos would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5194 1.3 christos p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5195 1.3 christos also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5196 1.3 christos p_offset value. */
5197 1.3 christos bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5198 1.3 christos off, align);
5199 1.1 skrll this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5200 1.1 skrll }
5201 1.1 skrll
5202 1.1 skrll if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5203 1.1 skrll {
5204 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5205 1.1 skrll /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5206 1.1 skrll a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5207 1.1 skrll file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5208 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5209 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5210 1.1 skrll }
5211 1.1 skrll else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5212 1.1 skrll {
5213 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5214 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5215 1.1 skrll
5216 1.1 skrll /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5217 1.1 skrll normal segments. */
5218 1.1 skrll else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5219 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5220 1.1 skrll }
5221 1.1 skrll
5222 1.1 skrll if (align > p->p_align
5223 1.1 skrll && !m->p_align_valid
5224 1.1 skrll && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5225 1.1 skrll || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5226 1.1 skrll p->p_align = align;
5227 1.1 skrll }
5228 1.1 skrll
5229 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5230 1.1 skrll {
5231 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5232 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5233 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5234 1.1 skrll if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5235 1.1 skrll p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5236 1.6 christos }
5237 1.1 skrll }
5238 1.1 skrll
5239 1.1 skrll off -= off_adjust;
5240 1.1 skrll
5241 1.1 skrll /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5242 1.3 christos Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5243 1.3 christos if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5244 1.1 skrll {
5245 1.3 christos bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5246 1.3 christos
5247 1.3 christos for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5248 1.3 christos if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5249 1.3 christos && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5250 1.3 christos ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5251 1.1 skrll && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5252 1.3 christos ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5253 1.3 christos {
5254 1.3 christos /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5255 1.1 skrll check_vma = FALSE;
5256 1.3 christos break;
5257 1.3 christos }
5258 1.3 christos
5259 1.3 christos for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5260 1.3 christos {
5261 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5262 1.3 christos asection *sec;
5263 1.3 christos
5264 1.3 christos sec = m->sections[i];
5265 1.3 christos this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5266 1.3 christos if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5267 1.3 christos && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5268 1.3 christos {
5269 1.3 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
5270 1.3 christos (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5271 1.3 christos abfd, sec, j);
5272 1.3 christos print_segment_map (m);
5273 1.3 christos }
5274 1.1 skrll }
5275 1.1 skrll }
5276 1.6 christos }
5277 1.1 skrll
5278 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5279 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5280 1.1 skrll }
5281 1.1 skrll
5282 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5283 1.1 skrll
5284 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5285 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5286 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5287 1.1 skrll {
5288 1.6 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5289 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5290 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5291 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5292 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5293 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
5294 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5295 1.1 skrll bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5296 1.1 skrll bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5297 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
5298 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
5299 1.6 christos
5300 1.6 christos i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5301 1.6 christos end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5302 1.1 skrll off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5303 1.1 skrll for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5304 1.1 skrll {
5305 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5306 1.1 skrll
5307 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
5308 1.1 skrll if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5309 1.1 skrll && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5310 1.1 skrll || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5311 1.1 skrll && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5312 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5313 1.5 christos else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5314 1.5 christos {
5315 1.5 christos if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5316 1.5 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
5317 1.5 christos (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5318 1.5 christos abfd,
5319 1.5 christos (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5320 1.1 skrll ? "*unknown*"
5321 1.1 skrll : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5322 1.1 skrll /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5323 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5324 1.1 skrll off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5325 1.1 skrll bed->maxpagesize);
5326 1.1 skrll else
5327 1.1 skrll off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5328 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_addralign);
5329 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5330 1.1 skrll FALSE);
5331 1.1 skrll }
5332 1.6 christos else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5333 1.6 christos && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5334 1.6 christos || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5335 1.6 christos && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5336 1.6 christos /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5337 1.6 christos || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5338 1.6 christos || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5339 1.6 christos && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5340 1.1 skrll || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5341 1.1 skrll || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5342 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5343 1.1 skrll else
5344 1.1 skrll off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5345 1.1 skrll }
5346 1.1 skrll
5347 1.1 skrll /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5348 1.1 skrll the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5349 1.1 skrll count = 0;
5350 1.1 skrll filehdr_vaddr = 0;
5351 1.1 skrll filehdr_paddr = 0;
5352 1.5 christos phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5353 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr = 0;
5354 1.6 christos hdrs_segment = NULL;
5355 1.1 skrll phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5356 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5357 1.1 skrll {
5358 1.1 skrll ++count;
5359 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5360 1.1 skrll continue;
5361 1.1 skrll
5362 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_filehdr)
5363 1.1 skrll {
5364 1.1 skrll filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5365 1.1 skrll filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5366 1.1 skrll }
5367 1.1 skrll if (m->includes_phdrs)
5368 1.1 skrll {
5369 1.1 skrll phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5370 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5371 1.5 christos if (m->includes_filehdr)
5372 1.1 skrll {
5373 1.1 skrll hdrs_segment = m;
5374 1.1 skrll phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5375 1.1 skrll phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5376 1.1 skrll }
5377 1.1 skrll }
5378 1.5 christos }
5379 1.5 christos
5380 1.5 christos if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5381 1.5 christos {
5382 1.5 christos /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5383 1.5 christos program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5384 1.5 christos A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5385 1.5 christos
5386 1.5 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5387 1.5 christos = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5388 1.5 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5389 1.5 christos /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5390 1.5 christos if (hash != NULL
5391 1.5 christos && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5392 1.5 christos || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5393 1.5 christos || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5394 1.5 christos || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5395 1.5 christos {
5396 1.5 christos asection *s = NULL;
5397 1.5 christos if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5398 1.5 christos /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5399 1.5 christos s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5400 1.6 christos else
5401 1.5 christos /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5402 1.5 christos for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5403 1.5 christos if (m->count != 0)
5404 1.5 christos {
5405 1.5 christos s = m->sections[0];
5406 1.5 christos break;
5407 1.5 christos }
5408 1.5 christos
5409 1.5 christos if (s != NULL)
5410 1.5 christos {
5411 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5412 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5413 1.5 christos }
5414 1.5 christos else
5415 1.5 christos {
5416 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5417 1.5 christos hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5418 1.5 christos }
5419 1.5 christos
5420 1.5 christos hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5421 1.5 christos hash->def_regular = 1;
5422 1.5 christos hash->non_elf = 0;
5423 1.5 christos }
5424 1.6 christos }
5425 1.1 skrll
5426 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5427 1.1 skrll {
5428 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5429 1.5 christos {
5430 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5431 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5432 1.1 skrll
5433 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
5434 1.1 skrll {
5435 1.6 christos /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5436 1.5 christos in link_info. */
5437 1.5 christos for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5438 1.1 skrll lm != NULL;
5439 1.1 skrll lm = lm->next, lp++)
5440 1.1 skrll {
5441 1.5 christos if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5442 1.5 christos && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
5443 1.1 skrll && lm->count != 0
5444 1.1 skrll && lm->sections[0]->vma >= link_info->relro_start)
5445 1.5 christos break;
5446 1.5 christos }
5447 1.1 skrll
5448 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (lm != NULL);
5449 1.1 skrll }
5450 1.1 skrll else
5451 1.1 skrll {
5452 1.1 skrll /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
5453 1.1 skrll library, but we need to use the same linker logic. */
5454 1.1 skrll for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
5455 1.1 skrll {
5456 1.1 skrll if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5457 1.1 skrll && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
5458 1.1 skrll break;
5459 1.1 skrll }
5460 1.1 skrll }
5461 1.1 skrll
5462 1.1 skrll if (lp < phdrs + count)
5463 1.1 skrll {
5464 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
5465 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
5466 1.1 skrll p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
5467 1.1 skrll if (link_info != NULL)
5468 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
5469 1.1 skrll else if (m->p_size_valid)
5470 1.1 skrll p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
5471 1.1 skrll else
5472 1.5 christos abort ();
5473 1.5 christos p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
5474 1.5 christos /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are valid. The
5475 1.5 christos gold linker generates RW/4 for the PT_GNU_RELRO section.
5476 1.5 christos It is better for objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5477 1.5 christos otherwise gdb will choke when using separate debug files.
5478 1.5 christos */
5479 1.5 christos if (!m->p_align_valid)
5480 1.6 christos p->p_align = 1;
5481 1.1 skrll if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5482 1.3 christos p->p_flags = PF_R;
5483 1.1 skrll }
5484 1.1 skrll else
5485 1.1 skrll {
5486 1.1 skrll memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5487 1.1 skrll p->p_type = PT_NULL;
5488 1.6 christos }
5489 1.6 christos }
5490 1.6 christos else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5491 1.6 christos {
5492 1.6 christos if (m->p_size_valid)
5493 1.1 skrll p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5494 1.1 skrll }
5495 1.6 christos else if (m->count != 0)
5496 1.1 skrll {
5497 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
5498 1.1 skrll if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5499 1.1 skrll && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5500 1.6 christos || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5501 1.6 christos {
5502 1.6 christos if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
5503 1.6 christos {
5504 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
5505 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
5506 1.6 christos (_("%B: warning: non-load segment includes file header and/or program header"),
5507 1.6 christos abfd);
5508 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5509 1.3 christos }
5510 1.1 skrll
5511 1.3 christos p->p_filesz = 0;
5512 1.3 christos p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
5513 1.3 christos for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
5514 1.3 christos {
5515 1.3 christos asection *sect = m->sections[i];
5516 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
5517 1.3 christos if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5518 1.3 christos {
5519 1.3 christos p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
5520 1.3 christos + hdr->sh_size);
5521 1.3 christos break;
5522 1.1 skrll }
5523 1.1 skrll }
5524 1.1 skrll }
5525 1.1 skrll }
5526 1.1 skrll else if (m->includes_filehdr)
5527 1.1 skrll {
5528 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
5529 1.1 skrll if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5530 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
5531 1.1 skrll }
5532 1.1 skrll else if (m->includes_phdrs)
5533 1.1 skrll {
5534 1.1 skrll p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
5535 1.1 skrll if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5536 1.1 skrll p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
5537 1.1 skrll }
5538 1.6 christos }
5539 1.1 skrll
5540 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5541 1.1 skrll
5542 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5543 1.6 christos }
5544 1.6 christos
5545 1.6 christos static elf_section_list *
5546 1.6 christos find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
5547 1.6 christos {
5548 1.6 christos for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
5549 1.6 christos if (list->ndx == i)
5550 1.6 christos break;
5551 1.6 christos return list;
5552 1.1 skrll }
5553 1.1 skrll
5554 1.1 skrll /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
5555 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
5556 1.1 skrll VMAs must be known before this is called.
5557 1.1 skrll
5558 1.1 skrll Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
5559 1.1 skrll "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
5560 1.1 skrll those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
5561 1.1 skrll stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
5562 1.1 skrll consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
5563 1.1 skrll image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
5564 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
5565 1.1 skrll
5566 1.1 skrll We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
5567 1.1 skrll
5568 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5569 1.1 skrll assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
5570 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5571 1.1 skrll {
5572 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
5573 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5574 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5575 1.1 skrll
5576 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
5577 1.1 skrll && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5578 1.1 skrll {
5579 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5580 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5581 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
5582 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
5583 1.1 skrll file_ptr off;
5584 1.1 skrll
5585 1.1 skrll /* Start after the ELF header. */
5586 1.1 skrll off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
5587 1.1 skrll
5588 1.1 skrll /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
5589 1.1 skrll not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
5590 1.1 skrll the sections in the file is unimportant. */
5591 1.1 skrll for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
5592 1.1 skrll {
5593 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5594 1.1 skrll
5595 1.1 skrll hdr = *hdrpp;
5596 1.6 christos if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5597 1.6 christos && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5598 1.6 christos || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5599 1.6 christos && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5600 1.6 christos /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5601 1.6 christos || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
5602 1.6 christos || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5603 1.6 christos && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5604 1.1 skrll || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
5605 1.1 skrll || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
5606 1.1 skrll {
5607 1.1 skrll hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5608 1.1 skrll }
5609 1.1 skrll else
5610 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5611 1.6 christos }
5612 1.1 skrll
5613 1.1 skrll elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5614 1.1 skrll }
5615 1.1 skrll else
5616 1.1 skrll {
5617 1.1 skrll unsigned int alloc;
5618 1.1 skrll
5619 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
5620 1.1 skrll assignment of sections to segments. */
5621 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5622 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5623 1.1 skrll
5624 1.1 skrll /* And for non-load sections. */
5625 1.1 skrll if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
5626 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5627 1.1 skrll
5628 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
5629 1.1 skrll {
5630 1.1 skrll if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
5631 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5632 1.6 christos }
5633 1.6 christos
5634 1.6 christos /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
5635 1.6 christos if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
5636 1.6 christos {
5637 1.6 christos unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
5638 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5639 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
5640 1.6 christos
5641 1.6 christos /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
5642 1.6 christos bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
5643 1.6 christos for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
5644 1.6 christos if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
5645 1.6 christos p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
5646 1.6 christos
5647 1.6 christos /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
5648 1.6 christos segments is non-zero. */
5649 1.6 christos if (p_vaddr)
5650 1.6 christos i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5651 1.1 skrll }
5652 1.6 christos
5653 1.1 skrll /* Write out the program headers. */
5654 1.1 skrll alloc = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5655 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
5656 1.1 skrll || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
5657 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5658 1.1 skrll }
5659 1.1 skrll
5660 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5661 1.1 skrll }
5662 1.1 skrll
5663 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5664 1.3 christos prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
5665 1.1 skrll {
5666 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
5667 1.1 skrll struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
5668 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5669 1.1 skrll
5670 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5671 1.1 skrll
5672 1.1 skrll shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
5673 1.1 skrll if (shstrtab == NULL)
5674 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5675 1.1 skrll
5676 1.1 skrll elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
5677 1.1 skrll
5678 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
5679 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
5680 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
5681 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
5682 1.1 skrll
5683 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
5684 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
5685 1.1 skrll bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
5686 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
5687 1.1 skrll
5688 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5689 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
5690 1.1 skrll else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
5691 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
5692 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5693 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
5694 1.1 skrll else
5695 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
5696 1.1 skrll
5697 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
5698 1.1 skrll {
5699 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_unknown:
5700 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
5701 1.1 skrll break;
5702 1.1 skrll
5703 1.1 skrll /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
5704 1.1 skrll e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
5705 1.1 skrll in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
5706 1.1 skrll the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
5707 1.1 skrll can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
5708 1.1 skrll unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
5709 1.1 skrll Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
5710 1.1 skrll e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
5711 1.1 skrll default:
5712 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
5713 1.1 skrll }
5714 1.1 skrll
5715 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
5716 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5717 1.1 skrll
5718 1.1 skrll /* No program header, for now. */
5719 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5720 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5721 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
5722 1.1 skrll
5723 1.1 skrll /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
5724 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
5725 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
5726 1.1 skrll
5727 1.1 skrll /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
5728 1.1 skrll if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
5729 1.1 skrll /* It all happens later. */
5730 1.1 skrll ;
5731 1.1 skrll else
5732 1.1 skrll {
5733 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5734 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5735 1.1 skrll }
5736 1.1 skrll
5737 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
5738 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
5739 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
5740 1.1 skrll (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
5741 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
5742 1.6 christos (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
5743 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5744 1.1 skrll || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5745 1.1 skrll || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
5746 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5747 1.1 skrll
5748 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5749 1.1 skrll }
5750 1.6 christos
5751 1.1 skrll /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
5752 1.6 christos of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
5753 1.6 christos
5754 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
5755 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
5756 1.6 christos {
5757 1.6 christos file_ptr off;
5758 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
5759 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
5760 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
5761 1.6 christos const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5762 1.1 skrll
5763 1.6 christos off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5764 1.6 christos
5765 1.6 christos shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5766 1.1 skrll end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5767 1.6 christos for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
5768 1.6 christos {
5769 1.6 christos shdrp = *shdrpp;
5770 1.6 christos if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
5771 1.6 christos {
5772 1.6 christos asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
5773 1.6 christos bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
5774 1.6 christos || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
5775 1.6 christos if (is_rel
5776 1.6 christos || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
5777 1.6 christos {
5778 1.6 christos if (!is_rel)
5779 1.6 christos {
5780 1.6 christos const char *name = sec->name;
5781 1.6 christos struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
5782 1.6 christos
5783 1.6 christos /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5784 1.6 christos if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
5785 1.1 skrll shdrp->contents))
5786 1.6 christos return FALSE;
5787 1.6 christos
5788 1.6 christos if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
5789 1.6 christos && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
5790 1.6 christos {
5791 1.6 christos /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
5792 1.6 christos section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
5793 1.6 christos char *new_name
5794 1.6 christos = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
5795 1.6 christos if (new_name == NULL)
5796 1.6 christos return FALSE;
5797 1.6 christos name = new_name;
5798 1.6 christos }
5799 1.6 christos /* Add setion name to section name section. */
5800 1.6 christos if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
5801 1.6 christos abort ();
5802 1.6 christos shdrp->sh_name
5803 1.6 christos = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
5804 1.6 christos name, FALSE);
5805 1.6 christos d = elf_section_data (sec);
5806 1.6 christos
5807 1.6 christos /* Add reloc setion name to section name section. */
5808 1.6 christos if (d->rel.hdr
5809 1.6 christos && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
5810 1.6 christos d->rel.hdr,
5811 1.6 christos name, FALSE))
5812 1.6 christos return FALSE;
5813 1.6 christos if (d->rela.hdr
5814 1.6 christos && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
5815 1.6 christos d->rela.hdr,
5816 1.6 christos name, TRUE))
5817 1.6 christos return FALSE;
5818 1.6 christos
5819 1.6 christos /* Update section size and contents. */
5820 1.6 christos shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
5821 1.6 christos shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
5822 1.6 christos shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
5823 1.6 christos }
5824 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
5825 1.6 christos off,
5826 1.6 christos TRUE);
5827 1.1 skrll }
5828 1.1 skrll }
5829 1.6 christos }
5830 1.6 christos
5831 1.6 christos /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
5832 1.6 christos compressed. */
5833 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
5834 1.6 christos shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
5835 1.6 christos shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
5836 1.6 christos off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
5837 1.6 christos
5838 1.6 christos /* Place the section headers. */
5839 1.6 christos i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5840 1.6 christos bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5841 1.6 christos off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
5842 1.6 christos i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
5843 1.6 christos off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
5844 1.6 christos elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5845 1.1 skrll
5846 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5847 1.1 skrll }
5848 1.1 skrll
5849 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
5850 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
5851 1.1 skrll {
5852 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5853 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
5854 1.6 christos bfd_boolean failed;
5855 1.1 skrll unsigned int count, num_sec;
5856 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
5857 1.1 skrll
5858 1.1 skrll if (! abfd->output_has_begun
5859 1.1 skrll && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
5860 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5861 1.1 skrll
5862 1.1 skrll i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5863 1.1 skrll
5864 1.1 skrll failed = FALSE;
5865 1.1 skrll bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
5866 1.1 skrll if (failed)
5867 1.6 christos return FALSE;
5868 1.6 christos
5869 1.1 skrll if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
5870 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5871 1.1 skrll
5872 1.1 skrll /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
5873 1.1 skrll num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5874 1.6 christos for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
5875 1.6 christos {
5876 1.6 christos i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
5877 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
5878 1.1 skrll i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
5879 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
5880 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
5881 1.1 skrll if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
5882 1.1 skrll {
5883 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
5884 1.1 skrll
5885 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5886 1.1 skrll || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
5887 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5888 1.1 skrll }
5889 1.1 skrll }
5890 1.6 christos
5891 1.1 skrll /* Write out the section header names. */
5892 1.6 christos t = elf_tdata (abfd);
5893 1.1 skrll if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
5894 1.1 skrll && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5895 1.1 skrll || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
5896 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5897 1.6 christos
5898 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
5899 1.1 skrll (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
5900 1.1 skrll
5901 1.1 skrll if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
5902 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
5903 1.6 christos
5904 1.6 christos /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
5905 1.1 skrll if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
5906 1.1 skrll return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
5907 1.1 skrll
5908 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
5909 1.1 skrll }
5910 1.1 skrll
5911 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
5912 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
5913 1.1 skrll {
5914 1.1 skrll /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
5915 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
5916 1.1 skrll }
5917 1.1 skrll
5918 1.1 skrll /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
5919 1.1 skrll
5920 1.1 skrll unsigned int
5921 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
5922 1.3 christos {
5923 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5924 1.1 skrll unsigned int sec_index;
5925 1.1 skrll
5926 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
5927 1.1 skrll && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
5928 1.1 skrll return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
5929 1.3 christos
5930 1.1 skrll if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
5931 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_ABS;
5932 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
5933 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
5934 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
5935 1.3 christos sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
5936 1.1 skrll else
5937 1.1 skrll sec_index = SHN_BAD;
5938 1.1 skrll
5939 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5940 1.3 christos if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
5941 1.1 skrll {
5942 1.1 skrll int retval = sec_index;
5943 1.1 skrll
5944 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
5945 1.1 skrll return retval;
5946 1.3 christos }
5947 1.1 skrll
5948 1.1 skrll if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
5949 1.3 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
5950 1.1 skrll
5951 1.1 skrll return sec_index;
5952 1.1 skrll }
5953 1.1 skrll
5954 1.1 skrll /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
5955 1.1 skrll on error. */
5956 1.1 skrll
5957 1.1 skrll int
5958 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
5959 1.1 skrll {
5960 1.1 skrll asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
5961 1.1 skrll int idx;
5962 1.1 skrll flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
5963 1.1 skrll
5964 1.1 skrll /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
5965 1.1 skrll own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
5966 1.1 skrll symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
5967 1.1 skrll relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
5968 1.1 skrll input sections rather than the output section. */
5969 1.1 skrll if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
5970 1.1 skrll && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
5971 1.1 skrll && asym_ptr->section)
5972 1.1 skrll {
5973 1.1 skrll asection *sec;
5974 1.1 skrll int indx;
5975 1.1 skrll
5976 1.1 skrll sec = asym_ptr->section;
5977 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
5978 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
5979 1.1 skrll if (sec->owner == abfd
5980 1.1 skrll && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
5981 1.1 skrll && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
5982 1.1 skrll asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
5983 1.1 skrll }
5984 1.1 skrll
5985 1.1 skrll idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
5986 1.1 skrll
5987 1.1 skrll if (idx == 0)
5988 1.1 skrll {
5989 1.1 skrll /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
5990 1.1 skrll which is used in a relocation entry. */
5991 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
5992 1.1 skrll (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
5993 1.1 skrll abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
5994 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
5995 1.1 skrll return -1;
5996 1.1 skrll }
5997 1.1 skrll
5998 1.1 skrll #if DEBUG & 4
5999 1.3 christos {
6000 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr,
6001 1.1 skrll "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
6002 1.1 skrll (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
6003 1.1 skrll fflush (stderr);
6004 1.1 skrll }
6005 1.1 skrll #endif
6006 1.1 skrll
6007 1.1 skrll return idx;
6008 1.1 skrll }
6009 1.1 skrll
6010 1.1 skrll /* Rewrite program header information. */
6011 1.1 skrll
6012 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6013 1.1 skrll rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6014 1.1 skrll {
6015 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6016 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map;
6017 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6018 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6019 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6020 1.1 skrll asection *section;
6021 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
6022 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_segments;
6023 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6024 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6025 1.1 skrll bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6026 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6027 1.1 skrll unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6028 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6029 1.1 skrll
6030 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6031 1.1 skrll iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6032 1.1 skrll
6033 1.1 skrll map_first = NULL;
6034 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6035 1.1 skrll
6036 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6037 1.1 skrll maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6038 1.1 skrll
6039 1.1 skrll /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6040 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6041 1.1 skrll (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6042 1.1 skrll ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6043 1.1 skrll
6044 1.1 skrll #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6045 1.1 skrll (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6046 1.1 skrll != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6047 1.1 skrll ? section->size : 0)
6048 1.1 skrll
6049 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6050 1.1 skrll the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6051 1.1 skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6052 1.1 skrll (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6053 1.1 skrll && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6054 1.1 skrll <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6055 1.1 skrll
6056 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6057 1.1 skrll the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6058 1.1 skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6059 1.1 skrll (section->lma >= base \
6060 1.1 skrll && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6061 1.1 skrll <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6062 1.1 skrll
6063 1.1 skrll /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6064 1.1 skrll #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6065 1.1 skrll (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6066 1.1 skrll && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6067 1.1 skrll && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6068 1.1 skrll && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6069 1.1 skrll <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6070 1.1 skrll
6071 1.1 skrll /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6072 1.1 skrll etc. */
6073 1.1 skrll #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6074 1.1 skrll (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6075 1.1 skrll && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6076 1.1 skrll && s->vma == 0 \
6077 1.1 skrll && s->lma == 0)
6078 1.1 skrll
6079 1.1 skrll /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6080 1.1 skrll linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6081 1.1 skrll p_memsz set to 0. */
6082 1.1 skrll #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6083 1.1 skrll (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6084 1.1 skrll && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6085 1.1 skrll && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6086 1.1 skrll && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6087 1.1 skrll && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6088 1.1 skrll && s->size > 0 \
6089 1.1 skrll && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6090 1.1 skrll && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6091 1.1 skrll <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6092 1.1 skrll
6093 1.1 skrll /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6094 1.1 skrll A section will be included if:
6095 1.1 skrll 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6096 1.5 christos if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6097 1.1 skrll 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6098 1.1 skrll segment.
6099 1.1 skrll 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6100 1.1 skrll 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6101 1.1 skrll 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6102 1.1 skrll 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6103 1.1 skrll 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6104 1.1 skrll 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6105 1.1 skrll (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6106 1.1 skrll #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6107 1.1 skrll ((((segment->p_paddr \
6108 1.1 skrll ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6109 1.1 skrll : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6110 1.1 skrll && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6111 1.1 skrll || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6112 1.1 skrll && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6113 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6114 1.1 skrll || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6115 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6116 1.1 skrll || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6117 1.1 skrll || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6118 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6119 1.1 skrll || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6120 1.1 skrll || (segment->p_paddr \
6121 1.1 skrll ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6122 1.1 skrll : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6123 1.1 skrll || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6124 1.1 skrll == 0)) \
6125 1.1 skrll && !section->segment_mark)
6126 1.1 skrll
6127 1.1 skrll /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6128 1.1 skrll it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6129 1.1 skrll #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6130 1.1 skrll (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6131 1.1 skrll && section->output_section != NULL)
6132 1.1 skrll
6133 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6134 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6135 1.1 skrll (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6136 1.1 skrll
6137 1.1 skrll /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6138 1.1 skrll their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6139 1.1 skrll It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6140 1.1 skrll ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6141 1.1 skrll to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6142 1.1 skrll LMA. */
6143 1.1 skrll #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6144 1.1 skrll ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6145 1.1 skrll || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6146 1.1 skrll && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6147 1.1 skrll || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6148 1.1 skrll
6149 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6150 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6151 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6152 1.1 skrll
6153 1.1 skrll /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6154 1.1 skrll p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6155 1.1 skrll file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6156 1.1 skrll don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6157 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6158 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6159 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6160 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6161 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6162 1.1 skrll {
6163 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6164 1.1 skrll break;
6165 1.1 skrll }
6166 1.1 skrll
6167 1.1 skrll /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6168 1.1 skrll of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6169 1.1 skrll in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6170 1.1 skrll parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6171 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6172 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6173 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6174 1.1 skrll {
6175 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
6176 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6177 1.1 skrll
6178 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6179 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6180 1.1 skrll if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6181 1.1 skrll {
6182 1.1 skrll /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6183 1.1 skrll assignment code will work. */
6184 1.1 skrll segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6185 1.1 skrll break;
6186 1.1 skrll }
6187 1.1 skrll
6188 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6189 1.1 skrll {
6190 1.1 skrll /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6191 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6192 1.1 skrll segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6193 1.1 skrll continue;
6194 1.1 skrll }
6195 1.1 skrll
6196 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6197 1.1 skrll for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6198 1.1 skrll {
6199 1.1 skrll bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6200 1.1 skrll
6201 1.1 skrll if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6202 1.1 skrll || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6203 1.1 skrll continue;
6204 1.1 skrll
6205 1.1 skrll /* Merge the two segments together. */
6206 1.1 skrll if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6207 1.1 skrll {
6208 1.1 skrll /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6209 1.1 skrll SEGMENT. */
6210 1.1 skrll extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6211 1.1 skrll - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6212 1.1 skrll
6213 1.1 skrll if (extra_length > 0)
6214 1.1 skrll {
6215 1.1 skrll segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6216 1.1 skrll segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6217 1.1 skrll }
6218 1.1 skrll
6219 1.1 skrll segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6220 1.1 skrll
6221 1.1 skrll /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6222 1.1 skrll i = 0;
6223 1.1 skrll segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6224 1.1 skrll break;
6225 1.1 skrll }
6226 1.1 skrll else
6227 1.1 skrll {
6228 1.1 skrll /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6229 1.1 skrll SEGMENT2. */
6230 1.1 skrll extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6231 1.1 skrll - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6232 1.1 skrll
6233 1.1 skrll if (extra_length > 0)
6234 1.1 skrll {
6235 1.1 skrll segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6236 1.1 skrll segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6237 1.1 skrll }
6238 1.1 skrll
6239 1.1 skrll segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6240 1.1 skrll }
6241 1.1 skrll }
6242 1.1 skrll }
6243 1.1 skrll
6244 1.1 skrll /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6245 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6246 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6247 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6248 1.1 skrll {
6249 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_count;
6250 1.1 skrll asection **sections;
6251 1.1 skrll asection *output_section;
6252 1.1 skrll unsigned int isec;
6253 1.1 skrll bfd_vma matching_lma;
6254 1.1 skrll bfd_vma suggested_lma;
6255 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
6256 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
6257 1.1 skrll asection *first_section;
6258 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
6259 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
6260 1.1 skrll
6261 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6262 1.1 skrll continue;
6263 1.1 skrll
6264 1.1 skrll first_section = NULL;
6265 1.1 skrll /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6266 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6267 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6268 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6269 1.1 skrll {
6270 1.1 skrll /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6271 1.1 skrll removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6272 1.1 skrll if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6273 1.1 skrll {
6274 1.1 skrll if (first_section == NULL)
6275 1.1 skrll first_section = section;
6276 1.1 skrll if (section->output_section != NULL)
6277 1.1 skrll ++section_count;
6278 1.1 skrll }
6279 1.1 skrll }
6280 1.1 skrll
6281 1.1 skrll /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6282 1.1 skrll all of the sections we have selected. */
6283 1.3 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6284 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6285 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6286 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
6287 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6288 1.1 skrll
6289 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6290 1.1 skrll using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6291 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
6292 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6293 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6294 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6295 1.1 skrll
6296 1.1 skrll /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6297 1.1 skrll no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6298 1.1 skrll output segment. */
6299 1.1 skrll if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6300 1.1 skrll {
6301 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6302 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6303 1.1 skrll }
6304 1.1 skrll
6305 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6306 1.1 skrll and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6307 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6308 1.1 skrll && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6309 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6310 1.1 skrll
6311 1.1 skrll if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6312 1.1 skrll {
6313 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs =
6314 1.1 skrll (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6315 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6316 1.1 skrll >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6317 1.1 skrll + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6318 1.1 skrll
6319 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6320 1.1 skrll phdr_included = TRUE;
6321 1.1 skrll }
6322 1.1 skrll
6323 1.1 skrll if (section_count == 0)
6324 1.1 skrll {
6325 1.1 skrll /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6326 1.1 skrll no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6327 1.1 skrll something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6328 1.6 christos a warning is produced. */
6329 1.6 christos if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
6330 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("\
6331 1.1 skrll %B: warning: Empty loadable segment detected, is this intentional ?"),
6332 1.1 skrll ibfd);
6333 1.1 skrll
6334 1.1 skrll map->count = 0;
6335 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
6336 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6337 1.1 skrll
6338 1.1 skrll continue;
6339 1.1 skrll }
6340 1.1 skrll
6341 1.1 skrll /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6342 1.1 skrll to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6343 1.1 skrll The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6344 1.1 skrll been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6345 1.1 skrll
6346 1.1 skrll 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6347 1.1 skrll In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6348 1.1 skrll input BFD.
6349 1.1 skrll
6350 1.1 skrll 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6351 1.1 skrll In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6352 1.1 skrll of the first section.
6353 1.1 skrll
6354 1.1 skrll 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6355 1.1 skrll In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6356 1.1 skrll placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6357 1.1 skrll and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6358 1.1 skrll have to be created to contain the other sections.
6359 1.1 skrll
6360 1.1 skrll 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6361 1.1 skrll In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6362 1.1 skrll of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6363 1.1 skrll or segments to contain the other sections.
6364 1.1 skrll
6365 1.1 skrll In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6366 1.1 skrll pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6367 1.3 christos to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6368 1.1 skrll
6369 1.1 skrll sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6370 1.1 skrll if (sections == NULL)
6371 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6372 1.1 skrll
6373 1.1 skrll /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6374 1.1 skrll Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6375 1.1 skrll Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6376 1.1 skrll case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6377 1.1 skrll we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6378 1.1 skrll more to do. */
6379 1.1 skrll isec = 0;
6380 1.1 skrll matching_lma = 0;
6381 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = 0;
6382 1.1 skrll first_matching_lma = TRUE;
6383 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6384 1.1 skrll
6385 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections;
6386 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6387 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6388 1.1 skrll if (section == first_section)
6389 1.1 skrll break;
6390 1.1 skrll
6391 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6392 1.1 skrll {
6393 1.1 skrll if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6394 1.1 skrll {
6395 1.1 skrll output_section = section->output_section;
6396 1.1 skrll
6397 1.1 skrll sections[j++] = section;
6398 1.1 skrll
6399 1.1 skrll /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6400 1.1 skrll We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6401 1.1 skrll correct value. Note - some backends require that
6402 1.1 skrll p_paddr be left as zero. */
6403 1.1 skrll if (!p_paddr_valid
6404 1.1 skrll && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6405 1.1 skrll && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6406 1.1 skrll && isec == 0
6407 1.1 skrll && output_section->lma != 0
6408 1.1 skrll && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
6409 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_filehdr
6410 1.1 skrll ? iehdr->e_ehsize
6411 1.1 skrll : 0)
6412 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_phdrs
6413 1.1 skrll ? (iehdr->e_phnum
6414 1.1 skrll * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6415 1.1 skrll : 0)))
6416 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6417 1.1 skrll
6418 1.1 skrll /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6419 1.1 skrll LMA address of the output section. */
6420 1.1 skrll if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6421 1.1 skrll || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6422 1.1 skrll || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6423 1.1 skrll && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6424 1.1 skrll {
6425 1.1 skrll if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
6426 1.1 skrll {
6427 1.1 skrll matching_lma = output_section->lma;
6428 1.1 skrll first_matching_lma = FALSE;
6429 1.1 skrll }
6430 1.1 skrll
6431 1.1 skrll /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6432 1.1 skrll then it does not overlap any other section within that
6433 1.1 skrll segment. */
6434 1.1 skrll map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6435 1.1 skrll }
6436 1.1 skrll else if (first_suggested_lma)
6437 1.1 skrll {
6438 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6439 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6440 1.1 skrll }
6441 1.1 skrll
6442 1.1 skrll if (j == section_count)
6443 1.1 skrll break;
6444 1.1 skrll }
6445 1.1 skrll }
6446 1.1 skrll
6447 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6448 1.1 skrll
6449 1.1 skrll /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6450 1.1 skrll if necessary. */
6451 1.1 skrll if (isec == section_count)
6452 1.1 skrll {
6453 1.1 skrll /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6454 1.1 skrll specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6455 1.1 skrll the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6456 1.1 skrll program header in the input BFD. */
6457 1.1 skrll map->count = section_count;
6458 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
6459 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6460 1.1 skrll
6461 1.1 skrll if (p_paddr_valid
6462 1.1 skrll && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6463 1.1 skrll && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
6464 1.1 skrll && !map->includes_filehdr
6465 1.1 skrll && !map->includes_phdrs)
6466 1.1 skrll /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6467 1.1 skrll segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6468 1.1 skrll segment's vma. */
6469 1.1 skrll map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
6470 1.1 skrll
6471 1.1 skrll free (sections);
6472 1.1 skrll continue;
6473 1.1 skrll }
6474 1.1 skrll else
6475 1.1 skrll {
6476 1.1 skrll if (!first_matching_lma)
6477 1.1 skrll {
6478 1.1 skrll /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
6479 1.1 skrll Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
6480 1.1 skrll LMA of the first section that fitted. */
6481 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
6482 1.1 skrll }
6483 1.1 skrll else
6484 1.1 skrll {
6485 1.1 skrll /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
6486 1.1 skrll Change the current segment's physical address to match
6487 1.1 skrll the LMA of the first section. */
6488 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6489 1.1 skrll }
6490 1.1 skrll
6491 1.1 skrll /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
6492 1.1 skrll to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
6493 1.1 skrll if (map->includes_filehdr)
6494 1.1 skrll {
6495 1.1 skrll if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
6496 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
6497 1.1 skrll else
6498 1.1 skrll {
6499 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
6500 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6501 1.1 skrll }
6502 1.1 skrll }
6503 1.1 skrll
6504 1.1 skrll if (map->includes_phdrs)
6505 1.1 skrll {
6506 1.1 skrll if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6507 1.1 skrll {
6508 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6509 1.1 skrll
6510 1.1 skrll /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
6511 1.1 skrll of program headers that we will need. Make a note
6512 1.1 skrll here of the number we used and the segment we chose
6513 1.1 skrll to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
6514 1.1 skrll offset when we know the correct value. */
6515 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
6516 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_seg = map;
6517 1.1 skrll }
6518 1.1 skrll else
6519 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6520 1.1 skrll }
6521 1.1 skrll }
6522 1.1 skrll
6523 1.1 skrll /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
6524 1.1 skrll those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
6525 1.1 skrll sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
6526 1.1 skrll possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
6527 1.1 skrll added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
6528 1.1 skrll to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
6529 1.1 skrll the loop. */
6530 1.1 skrll isec = 0;
6531 1.1 skrll do
6532 1.1 skrll {
6533 1.1 skrll map->count = 0;
6534 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = 0;
6535 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6536 1.1 skrll
6537 1.1 skrll /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
6538 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
6539 1.1 skrll {
6540 1.1 skrll section = sections[j];
6541 1.1 skrll
6542 1.1 skrll if (section == NULL)
6543 1.1 skrll continue;
6544 1.1 skrll
6545 1.1 skrll output_section = section->output_section;
6546 1.1 skrll
6547 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
6548 1.1 skrll
6549 1.1 skrll if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6550 1.1 skrll || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
6551 1.1 skrll {
6552 1.1 skrll if (map->count == 0)
6553 1.1 skrll {
6554 1.1 skrll /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
6555 1.1 skrll the beginning of the segment, then something is
6556 1.1 skrll wrong. */
6557 1.1 skrll if (output_section->lma
6558 1.1 skrll != (map->p_paddr
6559 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6560 1.1 skrll + (map->includes_phdrs
6561 1.1 skrll ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6562 1.1 skrll : 0)))
6563 1.1 skrll abort ();
6564 1.1 skrll }
6565 1.1 skrll else
6566 1.1 skrll {
6567 1.1 skrll asection *prev_sec;
6568 1.1 skrll
6569 1.1 skrll prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
6570 1.1 skrll
6571 1.1 skrll /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
6572 1.1 skrll and the start of this section is more than
6573 1.1 skrll maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
6574 1.1 skrll if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
6575 1.1 skrll maxpagesize)
6576 1.1 skrll < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
6577 1.1 skrll || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
6578 1.1 skrll > output_section->lma))
6579 1.1 skrll {
6580 1.1 skrll if (first_suggested_lma)
6581 1.1 skrll {
6582 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6583 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6584 1.1 skrll }
6585 1.1 skrll
6586 1.1 skrll continue;
6587 1.1 skrll }
6588 1.1 skrll }
6589 1.1 skrll
6590 1.1 skrll map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
6591 1.1 skrll ++isec;
6592 1.1 skrll sections[j] = NULL;
6593 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = TRUE;
6594 1.1 skrll }
6595 1.1 skrll else if (first_suggested_lma)
6596 1.1 skrll {
6597 1.1 skrll suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6598 1.1 skrll first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6599 1.1 skrll }
6600 1.1 skrll }
6601 1.1 skrll
6602 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
6603 1.1 skrll
6604 1.1 skrll /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
6605 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
6606 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6607 1.1 skrll
6608 1.1 skrll if (isec < section_count)
6609 1.1 skrll {
6610 1.1 skrll /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
6611 1.1 skrll segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
6612 1.1 skrll and carry on looping. */
6613 1.5 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6614 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6615 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6616 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
6617 1.1 skrll {
6618 1.1 skrll free (sections);
6619 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6620 1.1 skrll }
6621 1.1 skrll
6622 1.1 skrll /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
6623 1.1 skrll physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
6624 1.1 skrll not yet been assigned. */
6625 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
6626 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6627 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6628 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6629 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6630 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6631 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = 0;
6632 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6633 1.1 skrll }
6634 1.1 skrll }
6635 1.1 skrll while (isec < section_count);
6636 1.1 skrll
6637 1.1 skrll free (sections);
6638 1.6 christos }
6639 1.1 skrll
6640 1.1 skrll elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
6641 1.1 skrll
6642 1.1 skrll /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
6643 1.1 skrll going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
6644 1.1 skrll the offset if necessary. */
6645 1.1 skrll if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
6646 1.1 skrll {
6647 1.1 skrll unsigned int count;
6648 1.1 skrll
6649 1.1 skrll for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
6650 1.1 skrll count++;
6651 1.1 skrll
6652 1.1 skrll if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
6653 1.1 skrll phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
6654 1.1 skrll -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6655 1.1 skrll }
6656 1.1 skrll
6657 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_END
6658 1.1 skrll #undef SECTION_SIZE
6659 1.1 skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
6660 1.1 skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
6661 1.1 skrll #undef IS_NOTE
6662 1.1 skrll #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
6663 1.1 skrll #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
6664 1.1 skrll #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
6665 1.1 skrll #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
6666 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
6667 1.1 skrll #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
6668 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6669 1.1 skrll }
6670 1.1 skrll
6671 1.1 skrll /* Copy ELF program header information. */
6672 1.1 skrll
6673 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6674 1.1 skrll copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6675 1.1 skrll {
6676 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6677 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map;
6678 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6679 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6680 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6681 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
6682 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_segments;
6683 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6684 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6685 1.1 skrll
6686 1.1 skrll iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6687 1.1 skrll
6688 1.1 skrll map_first = NULL;
6689 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6690 1.1 skrll
6691 1.1 skrll /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
6692 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid. */
6693 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6694 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6695 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6696 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6697 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6698 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6699 1.1 skrll {
6700 1.1 skrll p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6701 1.1 skrll break;
6702 1.1 skrll }
6703 1.1 skrll
6704 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6705 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6706 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6707 1.1 skrll {
6708 1.1 skrll asection *section;
6709 1.1 skrll unsigned int section_count;
6710 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
6711 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6712 1.1 skrll asection *first_section = NULL;
6713 1.1 skrll asection *lowest_section;
6714 1.1 skrll
6715 1.1 skrll /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
6716 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6717 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6718 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6719 1.3 christos {
6720 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6721 1.3 christos if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6722 1.3 christos {
6723 1.1 skrll if (first_section == NULL)
6724 1.1 skrll first_section = section;
6725 1.1 skrll section_count++;
6726 1.1 skrll }
6727 1.1 skrll }
6728 1.1 skrll
6729 1.1 skrll /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6730 1.1 skrll all of the sections we have selected. */
6731 1.1 skrll amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6732 1.3 christos if (section_count != 0)
6733 1.1 skrll amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6734 1.1 skrll map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6735 1.1 skrll if (map == NULL)
6736 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
6737 1.1 skrll
6738 1.1 skrll /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
6739 1.1 skrll input segment. */
6740 1.1 skrll map->next = NULL;
6741 1.1 skrll map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6742 1.1 skrll map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6743 1.1 skrll map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6744 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6745 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6746 1.1 skrll map->p_align = segment->p_align;
6747 1.1 skrll map->p_align_valid = 1;
6748 1.6 christos map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
6749 1.6 christos
6750 1.1 skrll if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
6751 1.1 skrll || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
6752 1.1 skrll {
6753 1.1 skrll /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
6754 1.6 christos bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
6755 1.6 christos section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
6756 1.6 christos change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
6757 1.3 christos Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
6758 1.1 skrll systems. */
6759 1.1 skrll map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
6760 1.1 skrll map->p_size_valid = 1;
6761 1.1 skrll }
6762 1.1 skrll
6763 1.1 skrll /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6764 1.1 skrll and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6765 1.1 skrll map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6766 1.1 skrll && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6767 1.1 skrll
6768 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6769 1.1 skrll if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6770 1.1 skrll {
6771 1.1 skrll map->includes_phdrs =
6772 1.1 skrll (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6773 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6774 1.1 skrll >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6775 1.1 skrll + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6776 1.1 skrll
6777 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6778 1.1 skrll phdr_included = TRUE;
6779 1.6 christos }
6780 1.1 skrll
6781 1.1 skrll lowest_section = NULL;
6782 1.1 skrll if (section_count != 0)
6783 1.1 skrll {
6784 1.1 skrll unsigned int isec = 0;
6785 1.1 skrll
6786 1.1 skrll for (section = first_section;
6787 1.1 skrll section != NULL;
6788 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6789 1.3 christos {
6790 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6791 1.1 skrll if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6792 1.3 christos {
6793 1.3 christos map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
6794 1.3 christos if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6795 1.3 christos {
6796 1.6 christos bfd_vma seg_off;
6797 1.6 christos
6798 1.6 christos if (lowest_section == NULL
6799 1.6 christos || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
6800 1.3 christos lowest_section = section;
6801 1.3 christos
6802 1.3 christos /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
6803 1.3 christos p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
6804 1.3 christos If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
6805 1.3 christos with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
6806 1.3 christos invalid. */
6807 1.3 christos if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
6808 1.3 christos seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
6809 1.3 christos else
6810 1.3 christos seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
6811 1.3 christos if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
6812 1.1 skrll map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6813 1.1 skrll }
6814 1.1 skrll if (isec == section_count)
6815 1.1 skrll break;
6816 1.1 skrll }
6817 1.1 skrll }
6818 1.3 christos }
6819 1.3 christos
6820 1.3 christos if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
6821 1.5 christos /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
6822 1.3 christos map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
6823 1.3 christos
6824 1.3 christos if (!map->includes_phdrs
6825 1.3 christos && !map->includes_filehdr
6826 1.3 christos && map->p_paddr_valid)
6827 1.3 christos /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
6828 1.3 christos map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
6829 1.1 skrll - segment->p_paddr);
6830 1.1 skrll
6831 1.1 skrll map->count = section_count;
6832 1.1 skrll *pointer_to_map = map;
6833 1.1 skrll pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6834 1.6 christos }
6835 1.1 skrll
6836 1.1 skrll elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
6837 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6838 1.1 skrll }
6839 1.1 skrll
6840 1.1 skrll /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
6841 1.1 skrll information. */
6842 1.1 skrll
6843 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
6844 1.1 skrll copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6845 1.1 skrll {
6846 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6847 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6848 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6849 1.1 skrll
6850 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
6851 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
6852 1.1 skrll
6853 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6854 1.1 skrll {
6855 1.1 skrll /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
6856 1.1 skrll covered by ELF program header have changed. */
6857 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6858 1.1 skrll asection *section, *osec;
6859 1.1 skrll unsigned int i, num_segments;
6860 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
6861 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6862 1.1 skrll
6863 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6864 1.1 skrll
6865 1.1 skrll /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
6866 1.1 skrll if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
6867 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6868 1.1 skrll
6869 1.1 skrll /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
6870 1.1 skrll for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6871 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6872 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6873 1.1 skrll
6874 1.1 skrll num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6875 1.1 skrll for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6876 1.1 skrll i < num_segments;
6877 1.1 skrll i++, segment++)
6878 1.1 skrll {
6879 1.1 skrll /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
6880 1.1 skrll and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
6881 1.1 skrll which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
6882 1.1 skrll map in this case. */
6883 1.1 skrll if (segment->p_paddr == 0
6884 1.1 skrll && segment->p_memsz == 0
6885 1.1 skrll && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
6886 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6887 1.1 skrll
6888 1.1 skrll for (section = ibfd->sections;
6889 1.1 skrll section != NULL; section = section->next)
6890 1.1 skrll {
6891 1.1 skrll /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
6892 1.1 skrll from the input BFD. */
6893 1.1 skrll osec = section->output_section;
6894 1.1 skrll if (osec)
6895 1.1 skrll osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
6896 1.1 skrll
6897 1.3 christos /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
6898 1.1 skrll this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6899 1.1 skrll if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
6900 1.1 skrll {
6901 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
6902 1.1 skrll removed. What else do we need to check? */
6903 1.1 skrll if (osec == NULL
6904 1.1 skrll || section->flags != osec->flags
6905 1.1 skrll || section->lma != osec->lma
6906 1.1 skrll || section->vma != osec->vma
6907 1.1 skrll || section->size != osec->size
6908 1.1 skrll || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
6909 1.1 skrll || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
6910 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6911 1.1 skrll }
6912 1.1 skrll }
6913 1.1 skrll }
6914 1.1 skrll
6915 1.1 skrll /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
6916 1.1 skrll input BFD. */
6917 1.1 skrll for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6918 1.1 skrll section = section->next)
6919 1.1 skrll {
6920 1.1 skrll if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
6921 1.1 skrll goto rewrite;
6922 1.1 skrll else
6923 1.1 skrll section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6924 1.1 skrll }
6925 1.1 skrll
6926 1.1 skrll return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6927 1.1 skrll }
6928 1.5 christos
6929 1.5 christos rewrite:
6930 1.5 christos if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
6931 1.5 christos {
6932 1.5 christos /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
6933 1.5 christos the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
6934 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6935 1.5 christos unsigned int i;
6936 1.5 christos unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6937 1.5 christos bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
6938 1.5 christos
6939 1.5 christos for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6940 1.5 christos i < num_segments;
6941 1.5 christos i++, segment++)
6942 1.6 christos if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6943 1.6 christos && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
6944 1.6 christos {
6945 1.6 christos /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
6946 1.6 christos if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
6947 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("\
6948 1.6 christos %B: warning: segment alignment of 0x%llx is too large"),
6949 1.6 christos ibfd, (long long) segment->p_align);
6950 1.6 christos else
6951 1.5 christos maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
6952 1.5 christos }
6953 1.5 christos
6954 1.5 christos if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
6955 1.5 christos bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
6956 1.1 skrll }
6957 1.1 skrll
6958 1.1 skrll return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6959 1.1 skrll }
6960 1.1 skrll
6961 1.1 skrll /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
6962 1.1 skrll
6963 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
6964 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6965 1.1 skrll asection *isec,
6966 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
6967 1.1 skrll asection *osec,
6968 1.1 skrll struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6969 1.1 skrll
6970 1.6 christos {
6971 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6972 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
6973 1.1 skrll && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
6974 1.1 skrll
6975 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6976 1.1 skrll || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6977 1.5 christos return TRUE;
6978 1.5 christos
6979 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
6980 1.3 christos
6981 1.3 christos /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
6982 1.3 christos section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
6983 1.1 skrll set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
6984 1.3 christos that the linker clears to differ. */
6985 1.3 christos if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
6986 1.3 christos && (osec->flags == isec->flags
6987 1.3 christos || (final_link
6988 1.1 skrll && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
6989 1.1 skrll & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
6990 1.1 skrll elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
6991 1.1 skrll
6992 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
6993 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
6994 1.1 skrll & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
6995 1.1 skrll
6996 1.1 skrll /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
6997 1.1 skrll SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
6998 1.3 christos to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
6999 1.1 skrll See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7000 1.1 skrll if (!final_link)
7001 1.1 skrll {
7002 1.1 skrll if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7003 1.1 skrll || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
7004 1.1 skrll {
7005 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7006 1.2 skrll elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7007 1.1 skrll elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7008 1.6 christos elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7009 1.6 christos }
7010 1.6 christos
7011 1.6 christos /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7012 1.6 christos if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7013 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7014 1.1 skrll & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7015 1.1 skrll }
7016 1.1 skrll
7017 1.1 skrll ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7018 1.1 skrll
7019 1.1 skrll /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7020 1.1 skrll don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7021 1.1 skrll may be NULL at this point. */
7022 1.1 skrll if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7023 1.1 skrll {
7024 1.1 skrll ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7025 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7026 1.1 skrll elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7027 1.1 skrll }
7028 1.1 skrll
7029 1.1 skrll osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7030 1.1 skrll
7031 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7032 1.1 skrll }
7033 1.1 skrll
7034 1.1 skrll /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7035 1.1 skrll field, and sometimes the info field. */
7036 1.1 skrll
7037 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7038 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7039 1.1 skrll asection *isec,
7040 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
7041 1.1 skrll asection *osec)
7042 1.1 skrll {
7043 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7044 1.1 skrll
7045 1.1 skrll if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7046 1.1 skrll || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7047 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7048 1.1 skrll
7049 1.1 skrll ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7050 1.1 skrll ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7051 1.1 skrll
7052 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7053 1.1 skrll
7054 1.1 skrll if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7055 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7056 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7057 1.1 skrll || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7058 1.1 skrll ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7059 1.1 skrll
7060 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7061 1.1 skrll NULL);
7062 1.3 christos }
7063 1.3 christos
7064 1.3 christos /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7065 1.3 christos necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7066 1.3 christos the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7067 1.3 christos output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7068 1.1 skrll function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7069 1.1 skrll from the linker. */
7070 1.3 christos
7071 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7072 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7073 1.1 skrll {
7074 1.1 skrll asection *isec;
7075 1.3 christos
7076 1.1 skrll for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7077 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7078 1.1 skrll {
7079 1.3 christos asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7080 1.3 christos asection *s = first;
7081 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7082 1.1 skrll
7083 1.3 christos while (s != NULL)
7084 1.3 christos {
7085 1.3 christos /* If this member section is being output but the
7086 1.3 christos SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7087 1.3 christos set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7088 1.1 skrll if (s->output_section != discarded
7089 1.1 skrll && isec->output_section == discarded)
7090 1.1 skrll {
7091 1.1 skrll elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7092 1.3 christos elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7093 1.3 christos }
7094 1.3 christos /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7095 1.3 christos but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7096 1.3 christos else if (s->output_section == discarded
7097 1.1 skrll && isec->output_section != discarded)
7098 1.1 skrll removed += 4;
7099 1.1 skrll s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7100 1.1 skrll if (s == first)
7101 1.3 christos break;
7102 1.3 christos }
7103 1.3 christos if (removed != 0)
7104 1.3 christos {
7105 1.3 christos if (discarded != NULL)
7106 1.3 christos {
7107 1.3 christos /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7108 1.3 christos adjust the input section size. This function may
7109 1.3 christos be called multiple times, so save the original
7110 1.3 christos size. */
7111 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7112 1.3 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7113 1.3 christos isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7114 1.3 christos }
7115 1.3 christos else
7116 1.3 christos {
7117 1.3 christos /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7118 1.3 christos objcopy. */
7119 1.3 christos isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7120 1.1 skrll }
7121 1.1 skrll }
7122 1.1 skrll }
7123 1.1 skrll
7124 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7125 1.3 christos }
7126 1.3 christos
7127 1.3 christos /* Copy private header information. */
7128 1.3 christos
7129 1.3 christos bfd_boolean
7130 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7131 1.3 christos {
7132 1.3 christos if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7133 1.3 christos || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7134 1.3 christos return TRUE;
7135 1.3 christos
7136 1.3 christos /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7137 1.3 christos This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7138 1.3 christos entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7139 1.6 christos contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7140 1.3 christos already been worked out. */
7141 1.3 christos if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7142 1.3 christos {
7143 1.3 christos if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7144 1.3 christos return FALSE;
7145 1.3 christos }
7146 1.3 christos
7147 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7148 1.1 skrll }
7149 1.1 skrll
7150 1.1 skrll /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7151 1.1 skrll which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7152 1.1 skrll index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7153 1.1 skrll section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7154 1.1 skrll swap_out_syms function. */
7155 1.1 skrll
7156 1.1 skrll #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7157 1.1 skrll #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7158 1.1 skrll #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7159 1.1 skrll #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7160 1.1 skrll #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7161 1.1 skrll
7162 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7163 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7164 1.1 skrll asymbol *isymarg,
7165 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd,
7166 1.1 skrll asymbol *osymarg)
7167 1.1 skrll {
7168 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7169 1.1 skrll
7170 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7171 1.1 skrll || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7172 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7173 1.1 skrll
7174 1.1 skrll isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7175 1.1 skrll osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7176 1.1 skrll
7177 1.1 skrll if (isym != NULL
7178 1.1 skrll && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7179 1.1 skrll && osym != NULL
7180 1.1 skrll && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7181 1.1 skrll {
7182 1.1 skrll unsigned int shndx;
7183 1.1 skrll
7184 1.1 skrll shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7185 1.1 skrll if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7186 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7187 1.6 christos else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7188 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7189 1.6 christos else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7190 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
7191 1.6 christos else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7192 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7193 1.1 skrll else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7194 1.1 skrll shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7195 1.1 skrll osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7196 1.1 skrll }
7197 1.1 skrll
7198 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7199 1.1 skrll }
7200 1.1 skrll
7201 1.1 skrll /* Swap out the symbols. */
7202 1.1 skrll
7203 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
7204 1.1 skrll swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7205 1.1 skrll struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7206 1.1 skrll int relocatable_p)
7207 1.1 skrll {
7208 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7209 1.6 christos int symcount;
7210 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms;
7211 1.1 skrll struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7212 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7213 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7214 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7215 1.1 skrll struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7216 1.6 christos bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7217 1.6 christos bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7218 1.1 skrll unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7219 1.6 christos unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7220 1.1 skrll int idx;
7221 1.1 skrll unsigned int num_locals;
7222 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type amt;
7223 1.6 christos bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7224 1.1 skrll
7225 1.1 skrll if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7226 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7227 1.6 christos
7228 1.1 skrll /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7229 1.1 skrll stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7230 1.1 skrll if (stt == NULL)
7231 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7232 1.1 skrll
7233 1.1 skrll bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7234 1.1 skrll symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7235 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7236 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7237 1.6 christos symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7238 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7239 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7240 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7241 1.1 skrll
7242 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7243 1.6 christos symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7244 1.6 christos
7245 1.6 christos /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7246 1.6 christos symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7247 1.6 christos * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7248 1.6 christos if (symstrtab == NULL)
7249 1.6 christos {
7250 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7251 1.6 christos return FALSE;
7252 1.3 christos }
7253 1.3 christos
7254 1.1 skrll outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7255 1.1 skrll bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7256 1.6 christos if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7257 1.6 christos {
7258 1.6 christos error_return:
7259 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7260 1.1 skrll free (symstrtab);
7261 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
7262 1.6 christos }
7263 1.1 skrll symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7264 1.1 skrll outbound_syms_index = 0;
7265 1.6 christos
7266 1.6 christos outbound_shndx = NULL;
7267 1.6 christos outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7268 1.1 skrll
7269 1.6 christos if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7270 1.6 christos {
7271 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7272 1.6 christos if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7273 1.6 christos {
7274 1.6 christos amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7275 1.6 christos outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7276 1.6 christos bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7277 1.6 christos if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7278 1.6 christos goto error_return;
7279 1.6 christos
7280 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7281 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7282 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7283 1.1 skrll symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7284 1.6 christos symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7285 1.1 skrll }
7286 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7287 1.1 skrll }
7288 1.1 skrll
7289 1.1 skrll /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7290 1.1 skrll {
7291 1.1 skrll /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7292 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7293 1.1 skrll sym.st_name = 0;
7294 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = 0;
7295 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = 0;
7296 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = 0;
7297 1.5 christos sym.st_other = 0;
7298 1.6 christos sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7299 1.6 christos sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7300 1.6 christos symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7301 1.6 christos symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7302 1.1 skrll symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7303 1.6 christos outbound_syms_index++;
7304 1.1 skrll if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7305 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx_index++;
7306 1.1 skrll }
7307 1.1 skrll
7308 1.1 skrll name_local_sections
7309 1.1 skrll = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7310 1.1 skrll && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7311 1.6 christos
7312 1.1 skrll syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7313 1.1 skrll for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7314 1.1 skrll {
7315 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7316 1.1 skrll bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7317 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7318 1.1 skrll flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7319 1.1 skrll int type;
7320 1.1 skrll
7321 1.1 skrll if (!name_local_sections
7322 1.1 skrll && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7323 1.6 christos {
7324 1.1 skrll /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7325 1.1 skrll sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7326 1.1 skrll }
7327 1.6 christos else
7328 1.6 christos {
7329 1.6 christos /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7330 1.6 christos to get the final offset for st_name. */
7331 1.6 christos sym.st_name
7332 1.1 skrll = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7333 1.6 christos FALSE);
7334 1.1 skrll if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7335 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7336 1.1 skrll }
7337 1.1 skrll
7338 1.1 skrll type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7339 1.1 skrll
7340 1.1 skrll if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7341 1.1 skrll && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7342 1.1 skrll {
7343 1.1 skrll /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7344 1.1 skrll and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7345 1.1 skrll how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7346 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = value;
7347 1.1 skrll if (type_ptr == NULL
7348 1.1 skrll || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7349 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7350 1.1 skrll else
7351 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7352 1.1 skrll sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7353 1.1 skrll (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7354 1.1 skrll }
7355 1.1 skrll else
7356 1.1 skrll {
7357 1.1 skrll asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7358 1.1 skrll unsigned int shndx;
7359 1.1 skrll
7360 1.1 skrll if (sec->output_section)
7361 1.1 skrll {
7362 1.1 skrll value += sec->output_offset;
7363 1.1 skrll sec = sec->output_section;
7364 1.1 skrll }
7365 1.1 skrll
7366 1.1 skrll /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7367 1.1 skrll if (! relocatable_p)
7368 1.1 skrll value += sec->vma;
7369 1.1 skrll sym.st_value = value;
7370 1.1 skrll sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7371 1.1 skrll
7372 1.1 skrll if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7373 1.1 skrll && type_ptr != NULL
7374 1.1 skrll && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7375 1.1 skrll {
7376 1.1 skrll /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7377 1.1 skrll not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7378 1.1 skrll by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7379 1.1 skrll shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7380 1.1 skrll switch (shndx)
7381 1.1 skrll {
7382 1.1 skrll case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
7383 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7384 1.1 skrll break;
7385 1.1 skrll case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
7386 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7387 1.6 christos break;
7388 1.1 skrll case MAP_STRTAB:
7389 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7390 1.6 christos break;
7391 1.1 skrll case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
7392 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7393 1.6 christos break;
7394 1.6 christos case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
7395 1.1 skrll if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7396 1.1 skrll shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7397 1.5 christos break;
7398 1.1 skrll default:
7399 1.1 skrll shndx = SHN_ABS;
7400 1.1 skrll break;
7401 1.1 skrll }
7402 1.1 skrll }
7403 1.1 skrll else
7404 1.1 skrll {
7405 1.1 skrll shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7406 1.1 skrll
7407 1.1 skrll if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7408 1.1 skrll {
7409 1.1 skrll asection *sec2;
7410 1.1 skrll
7411 1.1 skrll /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7412 1.1 skrll we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7413 1.1 skrll knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7414 1.1 skrll demand of applications. For example, it
7415 1.1 skrll appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7416 1.1 skrll section of a symbol to be a section that is
7417 1.1 skrll actually in the output file. */
7418 1.1 skrll sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7419 1.1 skrll if (sec2 == NULL)
7420 1.1 skrll {
7421 1.1 skrll _bfd_error_handler (_("\
7422 1.1 skrll Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7423 1.1 skrll syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7424 1.6 christos sec->name);
7425 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7426 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
7427 1.1 skrll }
7428 1.1 skrll
7429 1.1 skrll shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7430 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (shndx != SHN_BAD);
7431 1.1 skrll }
7432 1.1 skrll }
7433 1.1 skrll
7434 1.1 skrll sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7435 1.1 skrll }
7436 1.1 skrll
7437 1.3 christos if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7438 1.3 christos type = STT_TLS;
7439 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7440 1.1 skrll type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7441 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
7442 1.1 skrll type = STT_FUNC;
7443 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
7444 1.1 skrll type = STT_OBJECT;
7445 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
7446 1.1 skrll type = STT_RELC;
7447 1.1 skrll else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
7448 1.1 skrll type = STT_SRELC;
7449 1.1 skrll else
7450 1.1 skrll type = STT_NOTYPE;
7451 1.1 skrll
7452 1.1 skrll if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
7453 1.1 skrll type = STT_TLS;
7454 1.1 skrll
7455 1.1 skrll /* Processor-specific types. */
7456 1.1 skrll if (type_ptr != NULL
7457 1.1 skrll && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7458 1.1 skrll type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7459 1.1 skrll (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
7460 1.1 skrll
7461 1.1 skrll if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7462 1.1 skrll {
7463 1.1 skrll if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7464 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7465 1.1 skrll else
7466 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
7467 1.1 skrll }
7468 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7469 1.1 skrll {
7470 1.1 skrll #ifdef USE_STT_COMMON
7471 1.1 skrll if (type == STT_OBJECT)
7472 1.3 christos sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_COMMON);
7473 1.1 skrll else
7474 1.1 skrll #endif
7475 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
7476 1.1 skrll }
7477 1.1 skrll else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
7478 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
7479 1.1 skrll ? STB_WEAK
7480 1.1 skrll : STB_GLOBAL),
7481 1.1 skrll type);
7482 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
7483 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
7484 1.1 skrll else
7485 1.1 skrll {
7486 1.1 skrll int bind = STB_LOCAL;
7487 1.1 skrll
7488 1.3 christos if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
7489 1.3 christos bind = STB_LOCAL;
7490 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
7491 1.1 skrll bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
7492 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
7493 1.1 skrll bind = STB_WEAK;
7494 1.1 skrll else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7495 1.1 skrll bind = STB_GLOBAL;
7496 1.1 skrll
7497 1.1 skrll sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
7498 1.1 skrll }
7499 1.5 christos
7500 1.5 christos if (type_ptr != NULL)
7501 1.5 christos {
7502 1.5 christos sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
7503 1.5 christos sym.st_target_internal
7504 1.1 skrll = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
7505 1.5 christos }
7506 1.5 christos else
7507 1.5 christos {
7508 1.5 christos sym.st_other = 0;
7509 1.1 skrll sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7510 1.6 christos }
7511 1.6 christos
7512 1.6 christos idx++;
7513 1.6 christos symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
7514 1.6 christos symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7515 1.6 christos symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7516 1.1 skrll
7517 1.6 christos outbound_syms_index++;
7518 1.1 skrll if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7519 1.1 skrll outbound_shndx_index++;
7520 1.6 christos }
7521 1.6 christos
7522 1.6 christos /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
7523 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
7524 1.6 christos
7525 1.6 christos /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
7526 1.6 christos for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
7527 1.6 christos {
7528 1.6 christos struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
7529 1.6 christos if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7530 1.6 christos elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
7531 1.6 christos else
7532 1.6 christos elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
7533 1.6 christos elfsym->sym.st_name);
7534 1.6 christos bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
7535 1.6 christos (outbound_syms
7536 1.6 christos + (elfsym->dest_index
7537 1.6 christos * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
7538 1.6 christos (outbound_shndx
7539 1.6 christos + (elfsym->destshndx_index
7540 1.6 christos * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
7541 1.6 christos }
7542 1.1 skrll free (symstrtab);
7543 1.6 christos
7544 1.1 skrll *sttp = stt;
7545 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
7546 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7547 1.1 skrll
7548 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
7549 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
7550 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
7551 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
7552 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
7553 1.1 skrll symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
7554 1.1 skrll
7555 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
7556 1.1 skrll }
7557 1.1 skrll
7558 1.1 skrll /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
7559 1.1 skrll
7560 1.1 skrll Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
7561 1.1 skrll the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
7562 1.1 skrll always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
7563 1.1 skrll
7564 1.1 skrll long
7565 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7566 1.1 skrll {
7567 1.1 skrll long symcount;
7568 1.1 skrll long symtab_size;
7569 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7570 1.1 skrll
7571 1.1 skrll symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
7572 1.1 skrll symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
7573 1.1 skrll if (symcount > 0)
7574 1.1 skrll symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
7575 1.1 skrll
7576 1.1 skrll return symtab_size;
7577 1.1 skrll }
7578 1.1 skrll
7579 1.1 skrll long
7580 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7581 1.1 skrll {
7582 1.1 skrll long symcount;
7583 1.1 skrll long symtab_size;
7584 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
7585 1.1 skrll
7586 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7587 1.1 skrll {
7588 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7589 1.1 skrll return -1;
7590 1.1 skrll }
7591 1.1 skrll
7592 1.1 skrll symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
7593 1.1 skrll symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
7594 1.1 skrll if (symcount > 0)
7595 1.1 skrll symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
7596 1.1 skrll
7597 1.1 skrll return symtab_size;
7598 1.1 skrll }
7599 1.1 skrll
7600 1.1 skrll long
7601 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7602 1.1 skrll sec_ptr asect)
7603 1.1 skrll {
7604 1.1 skrll return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
7605 1.1 skrll }
7606 1.1 skrll
7607 1.1 skrll /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
7608 1.1 skrll
7609 1.1 skrll long
7610 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
7611 1.1 skrll sec_ptr section,
7612 1.1 skrll arelent **relptr,
7613 1.1 skrll asymbol **symbols)
7614 1.1 skrll {
7615 1.1 skrll arelent *tblptr;
7616 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
7617 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7618 1.1 skrll
7619 1.1 skrll if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
7620 1.1 skrll return -1;
7621 1.1 skrll
7622 1.1 skrll tblptr = section->relocation;
7623 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
7624 1.1 skrll *relptr++ = tblptr++;
7625 1.1 skrll
7626 1.1 skrll *relptr = NULL;
7627 1.1 skrll
7628 1.1 skrll return section->reloc_count;
7629 1.1 skrll }
7630 1.1 skrll
7631 1.1 skrll long
7632 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
7633 1.1 skrll {
7634 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7635 1.1 skrll long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
7636 1.1 skrll
7637 1.1 skrll if (symcount >= 0)
7638 1.1 skrll bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
7639 1.1 skrll return symcount;
7640 1.1 skrll }
7641 1.1 skrll
7642 1.1 skrll long
7643 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
7644 1.1 skrll asymbol **allocation)
7645 1.1 skrll {
7646 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7647 1.1 skrll long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
7648 1.1 skrll
7649 1.1 skrll if (symcount >= 0)
7650 1.1 skrll bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
7651 1.1 skrll return symcount;
7652 1.1 skrll }
7653 1.1 skrll
7654 1.1 skrll /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
7655 1.1 skrll section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
7656 1.1 skrll or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
7657 1.1 skrll dynamic reloc section. */
7658 1.1 skrll
7659 1.1 skrll long
7660 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7661 1.1 skrll {
7662 1.1 skrll long ret;
7663 1.1 skrll asection *s;
7664 1.1 skrll
7665 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7666 1.1 skrll {
7667 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7668 1.1 skrll return -1;
7669 1.1 skrll }
7670 1.1 skrll
7671 1.1 skrll ret = sizeof (arelent *);
7672 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7673 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
7674 1.1 skrll && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
7675 1.1 skrll || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
7676 1.1 skrll ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
7677 1.1 skrll * sizeof (arelent *));
7678 1.1 skrll
7679 1.1 skrll return ret;
7680 1.1 skrll }
7681 1.1 skrll
7682 1.1 skrll /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
7683 1.1 skrll dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
7684 1.1 skrll associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
7685 1.1 skrll designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
7686 1.1 skrll one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
7687 1.1 skrll installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
7688 1.1 skrll dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
7689 1.1 skrll
7690 1.1 skrll long
7691 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
7692 1.1 skrll arelent **storage,
7693 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms)
7694 1.1 skrll {
7695 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
7696 1.1 skrll asection *s;
7697 1.1 skrll long ret;
7698 1.1 skrll
7699 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
7700 1.1 skrll {
7701 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7702 1.1 skrll return -1;
7703 1.1 skrll }
7704 1.1 skrll
7705 1.1 skrll slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
7706 1.1 skrll ret = 0;
7707 1.1 skrll for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7708 1.1 skrll {
7709 1.1 skrll if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
7710 1.1 skrll && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
7711 1.1 skrll || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
7712 1.1 skrll {
7713 1.1 skrll arelent *p;
7714 1.1 skrll long count, i;
7715 1.1 skrll
7716 1.1 skrll if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
7717 1.1 skrll return -1;
7718 1.1 skrll count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
7719 1.1 skrll p = s->relocation;
7720 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
7721 1.1 skrll *storage++ = p++;
7722 1.1 skrll ret += count;
7723 1.1 skrll }
7724 1.1 skrll }
7725 1.1 skrll
7726 1.1 skrll *storage = NULL;
7727 1.1 skrll
7728 1.1 skrll return ret;
7729 1.1 skrll }
7730 1.1 skrll
7731 1.1 skrll /* Read in the version information. */
7733 1.1 skrll
7734 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
7735 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
7736 1.1 skrll {
7737 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
7738 1.1 skrll unsigned int freeidx = 0;
7739 1.1 skrll
7740 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
7741 1.1 skrll {
7742 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7743 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
7744 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
7745 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
7746 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents_end;
7747 1.6 christos
7748 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
7749 1.6 christos
7750 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
7751 1.6 christos {
7752 1.6 christos error_return_bad_verref:
7753 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
7754 1.1 skrll (_("%B: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
7755 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7756 1.1 skrll error_return_verref:
7757 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
7758 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
7759 1.6 christos goto error_return;
7760 1.6 christos }
7761 1.6 christos
7762 1.6 christos contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7763 1.1 skrll if (contents == NULL)
7764 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7765 1.1 skrll
7766 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7767 1.6 christos || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7768 1.6 christos goto error_return_verref;
7769 1.6 christos
7770 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
7771 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
7772 1.1 skrll
7773 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
7774 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7775 1.1 skrll
7776 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
7777 1.1 skrll == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
7778 1.1 skrll contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
7779 1.1 skrll everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
7780 1.1 skrll iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
7781 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
7782 1.1 skrll {
7783 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
7784 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
7785 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
7786 1.1 skrll
7787 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
7788 1.1 skrll
7789 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
7790 1.1 skrll
7791 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_filename =
7792 1.6 christos bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7793 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_file);
7794 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
7795 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
7796 1.1 skrll
7797 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
7798 1.3 christos iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
7799 1.3 christos else
7800 1.3 christos {
7801 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
7802 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
7803 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
7804 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
7805 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verref;
7806 1.1 skrll }
7807 1.6 christos
7808 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_aux
7809 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7810 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
7811 1.1 skrll
7812 1.1 skrll evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7813 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
7814 1.1 skrll ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
7815 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
7816 1.1 skrll {
7817 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
7818 1.1 skrll
7819 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_nodename =
7820 1.6 christos bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7821 1.6 christos ivernaux->vna_name);
7822 1.6 christos if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
7823 1.6 christos goto error_return_bad_verref;
7824 1.1 skrll
7825 1.6 christos if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
7826 1.6 christos freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
7827 1.6 christos
7828 1.6 christos ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
7829 1.6 christos if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
7830 1.6 christos {
7831 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
7832 1.1 skrll break;
7833 1.1 skrll }
7834 1.1 skrll if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
7835 1.1 skrll ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
7836 1.6 christos
7837 1.1 skrll if (ivernaux->vna_next
7838 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
7839 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
7840 1.1 skrll
7841 1.1 skrll evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
7842 1.6 christos ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
7843 1.6 christos }
7844 1.6 christos
7845 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
7846 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
7847 1.1 skrll break;
7848 1.1 skrll if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
7849 1.1 skrll iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
7850 1.6 christos
7851 1.1 skrll if (iverneed->vn_next
7852 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
7853 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verref;
7854 1.1 skrll
7855 1.6 christos everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
7856 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
7857 1.1 skrll }
7858 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
7859 1.1 skrll
7860 1.1 skrll free (contents);
7861 1.1 skrll contents = NULL;
7862 1.1 skrll }
7863 1.1 skrll
7864 1.1 skrll if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
7865 1.1 skrll {
7866 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7867 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
7868 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
7869 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
7870 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
7871 1.1 skrll unsigned int i;
7872 1.1 skrll unsigned int maxidx;
7873 1.1 skrll bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
7874 1.6 christos
7875 1.6 christos hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
7876 1.6 christos
7877 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
7878 1.6 christos {
7879 1.6 christos error_return_bad_verdef:
7880 1.6 christos (*_bfd_error_handler)
7881 1.6 christos (_("%B: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
7882 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7883 1.6 christos error_return_verdef:
7884 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
7885 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
7886 1.3 christos goto error_return;
7887 1.1 skrll }
7888 1.6 christos
7889 1.1 skrll contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7890 1.1 skrll if (contents == NULL)
7891 1.6 christos goto error_return_verdef;
7892 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
7893 1.1 skrll || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
7894 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7895 1.1 skrll
7896 1.1 skrll BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
7897 1.1 skrll >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
7898 1.1 skrll contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
7899 1.1 skrll - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
7900 1.1 skrll contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
7901 1.1 skrll - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
7902 1.1 skrll
7903 1.1 skrll /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
7904 1.1 skrll index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
7905 1.1 skrll the maximum. */
7906 1.1 skrll everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7907 1.1 skrll maxidx = 0;
7908 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
7909 1.6 christos {
7910 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7911 1.1 skrll
7912 1.1 skrll if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
7913 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7914 1.6 christos if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
7915 1.6 christos maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
7916 1.6 christos
7917 1.1 skrll if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
7918 1.1 skrll break;
7919 1.6 christos
7920 1.1 skrll if (iverdefmem.vd_next
7921 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7922 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7923 1.1 skrll
7924 1.1 skrll everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
7925 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
7926 1.1 skrll }
7927 1.1 skrll
7928 1.1 skrll if (default_imported_symver)
7929 1.1 skrll {
7930 1.1 skrll if (freeidx > maxidx)
7931 1.1 skrll maxidx = ++freeidx;
7932 1.6 christos else
7933 1.3 christos freeidx = ++maxidx;
7934 1.6 christos }
7935 1.1 skrll
7936 1.6 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
7937 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
7938 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
7939 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7940 1.1 skrll
7941 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
7942 1.1 skrll
7943 1.1 skrll everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
7944 1.1 skrll iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
7945 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
7946 1.1 skrll {
7947 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
7948 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
7949 1.1 skrll unsigned int j;
7950 1.1 skrll
7951 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
7952 1.1 skrll
7953 1.1 skrll if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
7954 1.6 christos goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7955 1.1 skrll
7956 1.1 skrll iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
7957 1.1 skrll memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
7958 1.1 skrll
7959 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
7960 1.1 skrll
7961 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
7962 1.3 christos iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
7963 1.3 christos else
7964 1.3 christos {
7965 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
7966 1.1 skrll bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
7967 1.1 skrll sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
7968 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
7969 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
7970 1.1 skrll }
7971 1.6 christos
7972 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_aux
7973 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
7974 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7975 1.1 skrll
7976 1.1 skrll everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
7977 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
7978 1.1 skrll iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
7979 1.1 skrll for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
7980 1.1 skrll {
7981 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
7982 1.1 skrll
7983 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nodename =
7984 1.6 christos bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
7985 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_name);
7986 1.6 christos if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
7987 1.6 christos goto error_return_bad_verdef;
7988 1.6 christos
7989 1.6 christos iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
7990 1.6 christos if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
7991 1.6 christos {
7992 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
7993 1.1 skrll break;
7994 1.1 skrll }
7995 1.1 skrll if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
7996 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
7997 1.6 christos
7998 1.1 skrll if (iverdaux->vda_next
7999 1.1 skrll > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8000 1.1 skrll goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8001 1.1 skrll
8002 1.1 skrll everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8003 1.6 christos ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8004 1.1 skrll }
8005 1.1 skrll
8006 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8007 1.6 christos if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8008 1.6 christos iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8009 1.6 christos
8010 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8011 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8012 1.1 skrll break;
8013 1.1 skrll if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8014 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8015 1.1 skrll
8016 1.1 skrll everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8017 1.1 skrll ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8018 1.1 skrll }
8019 1.1 skrll
8020 1.1 skrll free (contents);
8021 1.1 skrll contents = NULL;
8022 1.1 skrll }
8023 1.1 skrll else if (default_imported_symver)
8024 1.1 skrll {
8025 1.1 skrll if (freeidx < 3)
8026 1.1 skrll freeidx = 3;
8027 1.3 christos else
8028 1.3 christos freeidx++;
8029 1.1 skrll
8030 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8031 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8032 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8033 1.1 skrll goto error_return;
8034 1.1 skrll
8035 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8036 1.1 skrll }
8037 1.1 skrll
8038 1.1 skrll /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8039 1.1 skrll if (default_imported_symver)
8040 1.1 skrll {
8041 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8042 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8043 1.1 skrll
8044 1.1 skrll iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8045 1.1 skrll
8046 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8047 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8048 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8049 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8050 1.1 skrll
8051 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8052 1.1 skrll
8053 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8054 1.6 christos if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8055 1.6 christos goto error_return_verdef;
8056 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8057 1.1 skrll iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8058 1.1 skrll bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8059 1.1 skrll if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8060 1.1 skrll goto error_return_verdef;
8061 1.1 skrll
8062 1.1 skrll iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8063 1.1 skrll iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8064 1.1 skrll }
8065 1.1 skrll
8066 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8067 1.1 skrll
8068 1.1 skrll error_return:
8069 1.1 skrll if (contents != NULL)
8070 1.1 skrll free (contents);
8071 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8072 1.1 skrll }
8073 1.1 skrll
8074 1.1 skrll asymbol *
8076 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8077 1.1 skrll {
8078 1.1 skrll elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8079 1.6 christos
8080 1.6 christos newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8081 1.1 skrll if (!newsym)
8082 1.1 skrll return NULL;
8083 1.1 skrll newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8084 1.1 skrll return &newsym->symbol;
8085 1.1 skrll }
8086 1.1 skrll
8087 1.1 skrll void
8088 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8089 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol,
8090 1.1 skrll symbol_info *ret)
8091 1.1 skrll {
8092 1.1 skrll bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8093 1.1 skrll }
8094 1.1 skrll
8095 1.1 skrll /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8096 1.1 skrll use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8097 1.1 skrll override it. */
8098 1.1 skrll
8099 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8100 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8101 1.1 skrll const char *name)
8102 1.1 skrll {
8103 1.1 skrll /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8104 1.1 skrll if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8105 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8106 1.1 skrll
8107 1.1 skrll /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8108 1.1 skrll DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8109 1.1 skrll if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8110 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8111 1.1 skrll
8112 1.1 skrll /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8113 1.1 skrll emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8114 1.1 skrll small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8115 1.1 skrll ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8116 1.1 skrll underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8117 1.6 christos we treat such symbols as local. */
8118 1.6 christos if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8119 1.6 christos return TRUE;
8120 1.6 christos
8121 1.6 christos /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8122 1.6 christos forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8123 1.6 christos These labels have the form:
8124 1.6 christos
8125 1.6 christos L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8126 1.6 christos
8127 1.6 christos [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8128 1.6 christos
8129 1.6 christos Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8130 1.6 christos so we only need to match the rest. */
8131 1.6 christos if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8132 1.6 christos {
8133 1.6 christos bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8134 1.6 christos const char * p;
8135 1.6 christos char c;
8136 1.6 christos
8137 1.6 christos for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8138 1.6 christos {
8139 1.6 christos if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8140 1.6 christos {
8141 1.6 christos if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8142 1.6 christos /* A fake symbol. */
8143 1.6 christos return TRUE;
8144 1.6 christos
8145 1.6 christos /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8146 1.6 christos L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8147 1.6 christos assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8148 1.6 christos containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8149 1.6 christos other than some kind of local ? */
8150 1.6 christos ret = TRUE;
8151 1.6 christos }
8152 1.6 christos
8153 1.6 christos if (! ISDIGIT (c))
8154 1.6 christos {
8155 1.6 christos ret = FALSE;
8156 1.6 christos break;
8157 1.6 christos }
8158 1.1 skrll }
8159 1.1 skrll return ret;
8160 1.1 skrll }
8161 1.1 skrll
8162 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8163 1.1 skrll }
8164 1.1 skrll
8165 1.1 skrll alent *
8166 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8167 1.1 skrll asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8168 1.1 skrll {
8169 1.1 skrll abort ();
8170 1.1 skrll return NULL;
8171 1.1 skrll }
8172 1.1 skrll
8173 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8174 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8175 1.1 skrll enum bfd_architecture arch,
8176 1.1 skrll unsigned long machine)
8177 1.1 skrll {
8178 1.1 skrll /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8179 1.1 skrll isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8180 1.1 skrll if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8181 1.1 skrll && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8182 1.1 skrll && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8183 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8184 1.1 skrll
8185 1.1 skrll return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8186 1.1 skrll }
8187 1.1 skrll
8188 1.1 skrll /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8189 1.6 christos for error reporting. */
8190 1.1 skrll
8191 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8192 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8193 1.1 skrll asymbol **symbols,
8194 1.6 christos asection *section,
8195 1.6 christos bfd_vma offset,
8196 1.5 christos const char **filename_ptr,
8197 1.1 skrll const char **functionname_ptr,
8198 1.1 skrll unsigned int *line_ptr,
8199 1.6 christos unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8200 1.1 skrll {
8201 1.6 christos bfd_boolean found;
8202 1.6 christos
8203 1.6 christos if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8204 1.6 christos filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8205 1.6 christos line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8206 1.6 christos dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8207 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8208 1.1 skrll || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8209 1.6 christos filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8210 1.6 christos line_ptr))
8211 1.6 christos {
8212 1.1 skrll if (!*functionname_ptr)
8213 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8214 1.1 skrll *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8215 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr);
8216 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8217 1.1 skrll }
8218 1.1 skrll
8219 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8220 1.1 skrll &found, filename_ptr,
8221 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8222 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8223 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8224 1.1 skrll if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8225 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8226 1.6 christos
8227 1.6 christos if (symbols == NULL)
8228 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8229 1.1 skrll
8230 1.1 skrll if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8231 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8232 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8233 1.1 skrll
8234 1.1 skrll *line_ptr = 0;
8235 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8236 1.1 skrll }
8237 1.1 skrll
8238 1.1 skrll /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8239 1.1 skrll
8240 1.6 christos bfd_boolean
8241 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8242 1.6 christos const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8243 1.6 christos {
8244 1.1 skrll return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8245 1.1 skrll filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8246 1.1 skrll dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8247 1.1 skrll &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8248 1.1 skrll }
8249 1.1 skrll
8250 1.1 skrll /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8251 1.1 skrll bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8252 1.1 skrll each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8253 1.1 skrll passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8254 1.1 skrll for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8255 1.1 skrll
8256 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8257 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8258 1.1 skrll const char **filename_ptr,
8259 1.1 skrll const char **functionname_ptr,
8260 1.1 skrll unsigned int *line_ptr)
8261 1.1 skrll {
8262 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean found;
8263 1.1 skrll found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8264 1.1 skrll functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8265 1.1 skrll & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8266 1.1 skrll return found;
8267 1.1 skrll }
8268 1.1 skrll
8269 1.1 skrll int
8270 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8271 1.6 christos {
8272 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8273 1.6 christos int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8274 1.1 skrll
8275 1.1 skrll if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8276 1.1 skrll {
8277 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8278 1.1 skrll
8279 1.1 skrll if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8280 1.6 christos {
8281 1.1 skrll struct elf_segment_map *m;
8282 1.1 skrll
8283 1.1 skrll phdr_size = 0;
8284 1.1 skrll for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8285 1.1 skrll phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8286 1.1 skrll
8287 1.6 christos if (phdr_size == 0)
8288 1.1 skrll phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8289 1.1 skrll }
8290 1.1 skrll
8291 1.1 skrll elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8292 1.1 skrll ret += phdr_size;
8293 1.1 skrll }
8294 1.1 skrll
8295 1.1 skrll return ret;
8296 1.1 skrll }
8297 1.1 skrll
8298 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8299 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8300 1.1 skrll sec_ptr section,
8301 1.1 skrll const void *location,
8302 1.6 christos file_ptr offset,
8303 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type count)
8304 1.1 skrll {
8305 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8306 1.1 skrll file_ptr pos;
8307 1.1 skrll
8308 1.6 christos if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8309 1.6 christos && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8310 1.6 christos return FALSE;
8311 1.1 skrll
8312 1.6 christos if (!count)
8313 1.6 christos return TRUE;
8314 1.6 christos
8315 1.6 christos hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8316 1.6 christos if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8317 1.6 christos {
8318 1.6 christos /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8319 1.6 christos unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8320 1.6 christos if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8321 1.6 christos || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8322 1.6 christos || contents == NULL)
8323 1.1 skrll abort ();
8324 1.1 skrll memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8325 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8326 1.1 skrll }
8327 1.1 skrll pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8328 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8329 1.1 skrll || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8330 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8331 1.1 skrll
8332 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8333 1.1 skrll }
8334 1.1 skrll
8335 1.1 skrll void
8336 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8337 1.1 skrll arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8338 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8339 1.1 skrll {
8340 1.1 skrll abort ();
8341 1.1 skrll }
8342 1.1 skrll
8343 1.1 skrll /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8344 1.1 skrll
8345 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8346 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8347 1.1 skrll {
8348 1.1 skrll /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8349 1.1 skrll
8350 1.1 skrll if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8351 1.1 skrll {
8352 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8353 1.1 skrll reloc_howto_type *howto;
8354 1.1 skrll
8355 1.1 skrll /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8356 1.1 skrll equivalent ELF reloc. */
8357 1.1 skrll
8358 1.1 skrll if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8359 1.1 skrll {
8360 1.1 skrll switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8361 1.1 skrll {
8362 1.1 skrll case 8:
8363 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8364 1.1 skrll break;
8365 1.1 skrll case 12:
8366 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8367 1.1 skrll break;
8368 1.1 skrll case 16:
8369 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8370 1.1 skrll break;
8371 1.1 skrll case 24:
8372 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8373 1.1 skrll break;
8374 1.1 skrll case 32:
8375 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8376 1.1 skrll break;
8377 1.1 skrll case 64:
8378 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8379 1.1 skrll break;
8380 1.1 skrll default:
8381 1.1 skrll goto fail;
8382 1.1 skrll }
8383 1.1 skrll
8384 1.1 skrll howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8385 1.1 skrll
8386 1.1 skrll if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8387 1.1 skrll {
8388 1.1 skrll if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8389 1.1 skrll areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8390 1.1 skrll else
8391 1.1 skrll areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8392 1.1 skrll }
8393 1.1 skrll }
8394 1.1 skrll else
8395 1.1 skrll {
8396 1.1 skrll switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8397 1.1 skrll {
8398 1.1 skrll case 8:
8399 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_8;
8400 1.1 skrll break;
8401 1.1 skrll case 14:
8402 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8403 1.1 skrll break;
8404 1.1 skrll case 16:
8405 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8406 1.1 skrll break;
8407 1.1 skrll case 26:
8408 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8409 1.1 skrll break;
8410 1.1 skrll case 32:
8411 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8412 1.1 skrll break;
8413 1.1 skrll case 64:
8414 1.1 skrll code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8415 1.1 skrll break;
8416 1.1 skrll default:
8417 1.1 skrll goto fail;
8418 1.1 skrll }
8419 1.1 skrll
8420 1.1 skrll howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8421 1.1 skrll }
8422 1.1 skrll
8423 1.1 skrll if (howto)
8424 1.1 skrll areloc->howto = howto;
8425 1.1 skrll else
8426 1.1 skrll goto fail;
8427 1.1 skrll }
8428 1.1 skrll
8429 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8430 1.1 skrll
8431 1.1 skrll fail:
8432 1.1 skrll (*_bfd_error_handler)
8433 1.1 skrll (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
8434 1.1 skrll abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8435 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8436 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8437 1.1 skrll }
8438 1.5 christos
8439 1.5 christos bfd_boolean
8440 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
8441 1.6 christos {
8442 1.1 skrll struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
8443 1.5 christos if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
8444 1.1 skrll {
8445 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
8446 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
8447 1.1 skrll _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8448 1.1 skrll }
8449 1.1 skrll
8450 1.1 skrll return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
8451 1.1 skrll }
8452 1.1 skrll
8453 1.1 skrll /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
8454 1.1 skrll in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
8455 1.1 skrll range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
8456 1.1 skrll this reloc. */
8457 1.1 skrll
8458 1.1 skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
8459 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
8460 1.1 skrll (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8461 1.1 skrll struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8462 1.1 skrll void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8463 1.1 skrll bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8464 1.1 skrll {
8465 1.1 skrll return bfd_reloc_ok;
8466 1.1 skrll }
8467 1.1 skrll
8468 1.1 skrll /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
8470 1.3 christos toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
8471 1.3 christos machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
8472 1.1 skrll out details about the corefile. */
8473 1.1 skrll
8474 1.1 skrll #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
8475 1.3 christos /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
8476 1.3 christos # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
8477 1.1 skrll # include <sys/procfs.h>
8478 1.1 skrll #endif
8479 1.1 skrll
8480 1.1 skrll /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
8481 1.3 christos PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
8482 1.3 christos
8483 1.6 christos static int
8484 1.3 christos elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
8485 1.6 christos {
8486 1.3 christos int pid;
8487 1.3 christos
8488 1.1 skrll pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
8489 1.1 skrll if (pid == 0)
8490 1.1 skrll pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
8491 1.1 skrll
8492 1.1 skrll return pid;
8493 1.1 skrll }
8494 1.1 skrll
8495 1.1 skrll /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
8496 1.1 skrll data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
8497 1.1 skrll reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
8498 1.1 skrll overwrite it. */
8499 1.1 skrll
8500 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8501 1.1 skrll elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
8502 1.1 skrll {
8503 1.1 skrll asection *sect2;
8504 1.1 skrll
8505 1.1 skrll if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
8506 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8507 1.1 skrll
8508 1.1 skrll sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
8509 1.1 skrll if (sect2 == NULL)
8510 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8511 1.1 skrll
8512 1.1 skrll sect2->size = sect->size;
8513 1.1 skrll sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
8514 1.1 skrll sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
8515 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8516 1.1 skrll }
8517 1.1 skrll
8518 1.1 skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
8519 1.1 skrll actually creates up to two pseudosections:
8520 1.1 skrll - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
8521 1.1 skrll such a section already exists.
8522 1.1 skrll - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
8523 1.1 skrll PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
8524 1.1 skrll Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
8525 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean
8526 1.1 skrll _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
8527 1.1 skrll char *name,
8528 1.1 skrll size_t size,
8529 1.1 skrll ufile_ptr filepos)
8530 1.1 skrll {
8531 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
8532 1.1 skrll char *threaded_name;
8533 1.1 skrll size_t len;
8534 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
8535 1.3 christos
8536 1.1 skrll /* Build the section name. */
8537 1.1 skrll
8538 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8539 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8540 1.1 skrll threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8541 1.1 skrll if (threaded_name == NULL)
8542 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8543 1.1 skrll memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
8544 1.1 skrll
8545 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
8546 1.1 skrll SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8547 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8548 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8549 1.1 skrll sect->size = size;
8550 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = filepos;
8551 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8552 1.1 skrll
8553 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
8554 1.1 skrll }
8555 1.1 skrll
8556 1.1 skrll /* prstatus_t exists on:
8557 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
8558 1.1 skrll linux 2.[01] + glibc
8559 1.1 skrll unixware 4.2
8560 1.1 skrll */
8561 1.1 skrll
8562 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8563 1.1 skrll
8564 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8565 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8566 1.1 skrll {
8567 1.1 skrll size_t size;
8568 1.1 skrll int offset;
8569 1.1 skrll
8570 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
8571 1.1 skrll {
8572 1.1 skrll prstatus_t prstat;
8573 1.1 skrll
8574 1.1 skrll size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
8575 1.6 christos offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
8576 1.6 christos memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
8577 1.6 christos
8578 1.6 christos /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
8579 1.1 skrll has already been set by another thread. */
8580 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8581 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
8582 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
8583 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
8584 1.1 skrll
8585 1.1 skrll /* pr_who exists on:
8586 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
8587 1.6 christos unixware 4.2
8588 1.3 christos pr_who doesn't exist on:
8589 1.6 christos linux 2.[01]
8590 1.1 skrll */
8591 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
8592 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
8593 1.1 skrll #else
8594 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
8595 1.1 skrll #endif
8596 1.1 skrll }
8597 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
8598 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
8599 1.1 skrll {
8600 1.1 skrll /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8601 1.1 skrll prstatus32_t prstat;
8602 1.1 skrll
8603 1.1 skrll size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
8604 1.6 christos offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
8605 1.6 christos memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
8606 1.6 christos
8607 1.6 christos /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
8608 1.1 skrll has already been set by another thread. */
8609 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8610 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
8611 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
8612 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
8613 1.1 skrll
8614 1.1 skrll /* pr_who exists on:
8615 1.1 skrll solaris 2.5+
8616 1.6 christos unixware 4.2
8617 1.3 christos pr_who doesn't exist on:
8618 1.6 christos linux 2.[01]
8619 1.1 skrll */
8620 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
8621 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
8622 1.1 skrll #else
8623 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
8624 1.1 skrll #endif
8625 1.1 skrll }
8626 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
8627 1.1 skrll else
8628 1.1 skrll {
8629 1.1 skrll /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8630 1.1 skrll note size (ie. data object type). */
8631 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8632 1.1 skrll }
8633 1.1 skrll
8634 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
8635 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
8636 1.1 skrll size, note->descpos + offset);
8637 1.1 skrll }
8638 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
8639 1.1 skrll
8640 1.1 skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
8641 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8642 1.1 skrll elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
8643 1.1 skrll char *name,
8644 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8645 1.1 skrll {
8646 1.1 skrll return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
8647 1.1 skrll note->descsz, note->descpos);
8648 1.1 skrll }
8649 1.1 skrll
8650 1.1 skrll /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
8651 1.1 skrll but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
8652 1.1 skrll data structure apart. */
8653 1.1 skrll
8654 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8655 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8656 1.1 skrll {
8657 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8658 1.1 skrll }
8659 1.1 skrll
8660 1.1 skrll /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
8661 1.1 skrll type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
8662 1.1 skrll literally. */
8663 1.1 skrll
8664 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8665 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8666 1.3 christos {
8667 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
8668 1.3 christos }
8669 1.3 christos
8670 1.3 christos /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
8671 1.3 christos with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
8672 1.3 christos contents literally. */
8673 1.3 christos
8674 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8675 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8676 1.1 skrll {
8677 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
8678 1.1 skrll }
8679 1.1 skrll
8680 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8681 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8682 1.1 skrll {
8683 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
8684 1.1 skrll }
8685 1.1 skrll
8686 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8687 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8688 1.3 christos {
8689 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
8690 1.3 christos }
8691 1.3 christos
8692 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8693 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8694 1.3 christos {
8695 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
8696 1.3 christos }
8697 1.3 christos
8698 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8699 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8700 1.3 christos {
8701 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
8702 1.3 christos }
8703 1.3 christos
8704 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8705 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8706 1.3 christos {
8707 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
8708 1.3 christos }
8709 1.3 christos
8710 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8711 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8712 1.3 christos {
8713 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
8714 1.3 christos }
8715 1.3 christos
8716 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8717 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8718 1.3 christos {
8719 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
8720 1.3 christos }
8721 1.3 christos
8722 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
8723 1.5 christos elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8724 1.5 christos {
8725 1.5 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
8726 1.5 christos }
8727 1.5 christos
8728 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
8729 1.5 christos elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8730 1.5 christos {
8731 1.5 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
8732 1.5 christos }
8733 1.5 christos
8734 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
8735 1.5 christos elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8736 1.6 christos {
8737 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
8738 1.6 christos }
8739 1.6 christos
8740 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
8741 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8742 1.6 christos {
8743 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
8744 1.6 christos }
8745 1.6 christos
8746 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
8747 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8748 1.6 christos {
8749 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
8750 1.6 christos }
8751 1.6 christos
8752 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
8753 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8754 1.5 christos {
8755 1.5 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
8756 1.5 christos }
8757 1.5 christos
8758 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
8759 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8760 1.6 christos {
8761 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
8762 1.6 christos }
8763 1.6 christos
8764 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
8765 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8766 1.6 christos {
8767 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
8768 1.6 christos }
8769 1.6 christos
8770 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
8771 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8772 1.6 christos {
8773 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
8774 1.6 christos }
8775 1.6 christos
8776 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
8777 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8778 1.1 skrll {
8779 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
8780 1.1 skrll }
8781 1.1 skrll
8782 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
8783 1.1 skrll typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
8784 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
8785 1.1 skrll typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
8786 1.1 skrll #endif
8787 1.1 skrll #endif
8788 1.1 skrll
8789 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8790 1.1 skrll typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
8791 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
8792 1.1 skrll typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
8793 1.1 skrll #endif
8794 1.1 skrll #endif
8795 1.1 skrll
8796 1.1 skrll /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
8797 1.1 skrll most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
8798 1.1 skrll the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
8799 1.3 christos
8800 1.1 skrll char *
8801 1.1 skrll _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
8802 1.1 skrll {
8803 1.1 skrll char *dups;
8804 1.1 skrll char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
8805 1.1 skrll size_t len;
8806 1.1 skrll
8807 1.3 christos if (end == NULL)
8808 1.1 skrll len = max;
8809 1.1 skrll else
8810 1.1 skrll len = end - start;
8811 1.1 skrll
8812 1.1 skrll dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
8813 1.1 skrll if (dups == NULL)
8814 1.1 skrll return NULL;
8815 1.1 skrll
8816 1.1 skrll memcpy (dups, start, len);
8817 1.1 skrll dups[len] = '\0';
8818 1.1 skrll
8819 1.1 skrll return dups;
8820 1.1 skrll }
8821 1.1 skrll
8822 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8823 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8824 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8825 1.1 skrll {
8826 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
8827 1.3 christos {
8828 1.6 christos elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
8829 1.3 christos
8830 1.6 christos memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8831 1.1 skrll
8832 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
8833 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8834 1.6 christos #endif
8835 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
8836 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8837 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8838 1.1 skrll
8839 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8840 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8841 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8842 1.1 skrll }
8843 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8844 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
8845 1.1 skrll {
8846 1.3 christos /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8847 1.6 christos elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
8848 1.3 christos
8849 1.6 christos memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
8850 1.1 skrll
8851 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
8852 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
8853 1.6 christos #endif
8854 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
8855 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
8856 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
8857 1.1 skrll
8858 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
8859 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
8860 1.1 skrll sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
8861 1.1 skrll }
8862 1.1 skrll #endif
8863 1.1 skrll
8864 1.1 skrll else
8865 1.1 skrll {
8866 1.1 skrll /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
8867 1.1 skrll note size (ie. data object type). */
8868 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8869 1.1 skrll }
8870 1.1 skrll
8871 1.6 christos /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
8872 1.1 skrll onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
8873 1.1 skrll implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
8874 1.1 skrll
8875 1.1 skrll {
8876 1.1 skrll char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
8877 1.1 skrll int n = strlen (command);
8878 1.1 skrll
8879 1.1 skrll if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
8880 1.1 skrll command[n - 1] = '\0';
8881 1.1 skrll }
8882 1.1 skrll
8883 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8884 1.1 skrll }
8885 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
8886 1.1 skrll
8887 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8888 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8889 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8890 1.1 skrll {
8891 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
8892 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
8893 1.1 skrll || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
8894 1.1 skrll #endif
8895 1.1 skrll )
8896 1.6 christos {
8897 1.1 skrll pstatus_t pstat;
8898 1.1 skrll
8899 1.1 skrll memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8900 1.1 skrll
8901 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8902 1.1 skrll }
8903 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
8904 1.1 skrll else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
8905 1.1 skrll {
8906 1.6 christos /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
8907 1.1 skrll pstatus32_t pstat;
8908 1.1 skrll
8909 1.1 skrll memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
8910 1.1 skrll
8911 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
8912 1.1 skrll }
8913 1.1 skrll #endif
8914 1.1 skrll /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
8915 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
8916 1.1 skrll NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
8917 1.1 skrll
8918 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
8919 1.1 skrll }
8920 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
8921 1.1 skrll
8922 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8923 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
8924 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8925 1.1 skrll {
8926 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8927 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
8928 1.1 skrll char *name;
8929 1.1 skrll size_t len;
8930 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
8931 1.1 skrll
8932 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
8933 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
8934 1.1 skrll && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
8935 1.1 skrll #endif
8936 1.6 christos )
8937 1.3 christos return TRUE;
8938 1.3 christos
8939 1.6 christos memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
8940 1.6 christos
8941 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
8942 1.1 skrll /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
8943 1.1 skrll another thread. */
8944 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
8945 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
8946 1.1 skrll
8947 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
8948 1.1 skrll
8949 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8950 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8951 1.1 skrll name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8952 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8953 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8954 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
8955 1.1 skrll
8956 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8957 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8958 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8959 1.1 skrll
8960 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8961 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8962 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos
8963 1.1 skrll + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
8964 1.1 skrll #endif
8965 1.1 skrll
8966 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8967 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
8968 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
8969 1.1 skrll #endif
8970 1.1 skrll
8971 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
8972 1.1 skrll
8973 1.1 skrll if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
8974 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8975 1.1 skrll
8976 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
8977 1.1 skrll
8978 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8979 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8980 1.1 skrll name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8981 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
8982 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8983 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
8984 1.1 skrll
8985 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8986 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
8987 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
8988 1.1 skrll
8989 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8990 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8991 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos
8992 1.1 skrll + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
8993 1.1 skrll #endif
8994 1.1 skrll
8995 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
8996 1.1 skrll sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
8997 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
8998 1.1 skrll #endif
8999 1.1 skrll
9000 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9001 1.1 skrll
9002 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9003 1.1 skrll }
9004 1.1 skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9005 1.1 skrll
9006 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9007 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9008 1.1 skrll {
9009 1.1 skrll char buf[30];
9010 1.1 skrll char *name;
9011 1.1 skrll size_t len;
9012 1.1 skrll asection *sect;
9013 1.1 skrll int type;
9014 1.1 skrll int is_active_thread;
9015 1.1 skrll bfd_vma base_addr;
9016 1.1 skrll
9017 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz < 728)
9018 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9019 1.1 skrll
9020 1.1 skrll if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9021 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9022 1.1 skrll
9023 1.6 christos type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9024 1.1 skrll
9025 1.6 christos switch (type)
9026 1.1 skrll {
9027 1.6 christos case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9028 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9029 1.1 skrll /* process_info.pid */
9030 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9031 1.1 skrll /* process_info.signal */
9032 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9033 1.1 skrll break;
9034 1.1 skrll
9035 1.1 skrll case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9036 1.3 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9037 1.1 skrll /* thread_info.tid */
9038 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9039 1.1 skrll
9040 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9041 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9042 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9043 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9044 1.1 skrll
9045 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
9046 1.1 skrll
9047 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9048 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9049 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9050 1.1 skrll
9051 1.1 skrll /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9052 1.1 skrll sect->size = 716;
9053 1.1 skrll /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9054 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9055 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9056 1.1 skrll
9057 1.1 skrll /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9058 1.1 skrll is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9059 1.1 skrll
9060 1.1 skrll if (is_active_thread)
9061 1.1 skrll if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9062 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9063 1.1 skrll break;
9064 1.1 skrll
9065 1.1 skrll case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9066 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9067 1.3 christos /* module_info.base_address */
9068 1.1 skrll base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9069 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9070 1.1 skrll
9071 1.1 skrll len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9072 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9073 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9074 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9075 1.1 skrll
9076 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, buf, len);
9077 1.1 skrll
9078 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9079 1.1 skrll
9080 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9081 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9082 1.1 skrll
9083 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
9084 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9085 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9086 1.1 skrll break;
9087 1.1 skrll
9088 1.1 skrll default:
9089 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9090 1.1 skrll }
9091 1.1 skrll
9092 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9093 1.1 skrll }
9094 1.1 skrll
9095 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9096 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9097 1.1 skrll {
9098 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9099 1.1 skrll
9100 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
9101 1.1 skrll {
9102 1.1 skrll default:
9103 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9104 1.1 skrll
9105 1.1 skrll case NT_PRSTATUS:
9106 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9107 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9108 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9109 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9110 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9111 1.1 skrll #else
9112 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9113 1.1 skrll #endif
9114 1.1 skrll
9115 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9116 1.1 skrll case NT_PSTATUS:
9117 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9118 1.1 skrll #endif
9119 1.1 skrll
9120 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9121 1.1 skrll case NT_LWPSTATUS:
9122 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9123 1.1 skrll #endif
9124 1.1 skrll
9125 1.1 skrll case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9126 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9127 1.1 skrll
9128 1.1 skrll case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9129 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9130 1.1 skrll
9131 1.1 skrll case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9132 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
9133 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9134 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9135 1.3 christos else
9136 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9137 1.6 christos
9138 1.6 christos case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9139 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9140 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9141 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9142 1.3 christos else if (note->namesz == 8
9143 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "FreeBSD") == 0)
9144 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9145 1.1 skrll else
9146 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9147 1.1 skrll
9148 1.1 skrll case NT_PPC_VMX:
9149 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
9150 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9151 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9152 1.1 skrll else
9153 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9154 1.1 skrll
9155 1.1 skrll case NT_PPC_VSX:
9156 1.1 skrll if (note->namesz == 6
9157 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9158 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9159 1.3 christos else
9160 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9161 1.3 christos
9162 1.3 christos case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9163 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9164 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9165 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9166 1.3 christos else
9167 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9168 1.3 christos
9169 1.3 christos case NT_S390_TIMER:
9170 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9171 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9172 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9173 1.3 christos else
9174 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9175 1.3 christos
9176 1.3 christos case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9177 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9178 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9179 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9180 1.3 christos else
9181 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9182 1.3 christos
9183 1.3 christos case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9184 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9185 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9186 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9187 1.3 christos else
9188 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9189 1.3 christos
9190 1.3 christos case NT_S390_CTRS:
9191 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9192 1.3 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9193 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9194 1.3 christos else
9195 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9196 1.3 christos
9197 1.3 christos case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9198 1.3 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9199 1.5 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9200 1.5 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9201 1.5 christos else
9202 1.5 christos return TRUE;
9203 1.5 christos
9204 1.5 christos case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9205 1.5 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9206 1.5 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9207 1.5 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9208 1.5 christos else
9209 1.5 christos return TRUE;
9210 1.5 christos
9211 1.5 christos case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9212 1.5 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9213 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9214 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9215 1.6 christos else
9216 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9217 1.6 christos
9218 1.6 christos case NT_S390_TDB:
9219 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9220 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9221 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9222 1.6 christos else
9223 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9224 1.6 christos
9225 1.6 christos case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9226 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9227 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9228 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9229 1.6 christos else
9230 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9231 1.6 christos
9232 1.6 christos case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9233 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9234 1.5 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9235 1.5 christos return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9236 1.5 christos else
9237 1.5 christos return TRUE;
9238 1.5 christos
9239 1.5 christos case NT_ARM_VFP:
9240 1.5 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9241 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9242 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
9243 1.6 christos else
9244 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9245 1.6 christos
9246 1.6 christos case NT_ARM_TLS:
9247 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9248 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9249 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
9250 1.6 christos else
9251 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9252 1.6 christos
9253 1.6 christos case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
9254 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9255 1.6 christos && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9256 1.6 christos return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
9257 1.6 christos else
9258 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9259 1.6 christos
9260 1.6 christos case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
9261 1.6 christos if (note->namesz == 6
9262 1.1 skrll && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9263 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
9264 1.1 skrll else
9265 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9266 1.1 skrll
9267 1.1 skrll case NT_PRPSINFO:
9268 1.1 skrll case NT_PSINFO:
9269 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
9270 1.1 skrll if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
9271 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9272 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9273 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
9274 1.1 skrll #else
9275 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9276 1.1 skrll #endif
9277 1.1 skrll
9278 1.1 skrll case NT_AUXV:
9279 1.1 skrll {
9280 1.1 skrll asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9281 1.1 skrll SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9282 1.1 skrll
9283 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9284 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9285 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
9286 1.6 christos sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9287 1.6 christos sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9288 1.6 christos
9289 1.6 christos return TRUE;
9290 1.6 christos }
9291 1.6 christos
9292 1.6 christos case NT_FILE:
9293 1.6 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
9294 1.1 skrll note);
9295 1.1 skrll
9296 1.1 skrll case NT_SIGINFO:
9297 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
9298 1.1 skrll note);
9299 1.1 skrll }
9300 1.6 christos }
9301 1.6 christos
9302 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
9303 1.6 christos elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9304 1.6 christos {
9305 1.6 christos struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
9306 1.6 christos
9307 1.1 skrll if (note->descsz == 0)
9308 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9309 1.6 christos
9310 1.6 christos build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
9311 1.6 christos if (build_id == NULL)
9312 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9313 1.1 skrll
9314 1.1 skrll build_id->size = note->descsz;
9315 1.1 skrll memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9316 1.1 skrll abfd->build_id = build_id;
9317 1.1 skrll
9318 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9319 1.1 skrll }
9320 1.1 skrll
9321 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9322 1.1 skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9323 1.1 skrll {
9324 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
9325 1.1 skrll {
9326 1.1 skrll default:
9327 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9328 1.1 skrll
9329 1.1 skrll case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
9330 1.5 christos return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
9331 1.5 christos }
9332 1.5 christos }
9333 1.5 christos
9334 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
9335 1.5 christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9336 1.5 christos {
9337 1.5 christos struct sdt_note *cur =
9338 1.5 christos (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
9339 1.5 christos + note->descsz);
9340 1.5 christos
9341 1.5 christos cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
9342 1.5 christos cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
9343 1.5 christos memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9344 1.5 christos
9345 1.5 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
9346 1.5 christos
9347 1.5 christos return TRUE;
9348 1.5 christos }
9349 1.5 christos
9350 1.5 christos static bfd_boolean
9351 1.5 christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9352 1.5 christos {
9353 1.5 christos switch (note->type)
9354 1.5 christos {
9355 1.5 christos case NT_STAPSDT:
9356 1.5 christos return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
9357 1.5 christos
9358 1.5 christos default:
9359 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9360 1.1 skrll }
9361 1.1 skrll }
9362 1.1 skrll
9363 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9364 1.1 skrll elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
9365 1.1 skrll {
9366 1.1 skrll char *cp;
9367 1.1 skrll
9368 1.1 skrll cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
9369 1.1 skrll if (cp != NULL)
9370 1.1 skrll {
9371 1.1 skrll *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
9372 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9373 1.1 skrll }
9374 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9375 1.1 skrll }
9376 1.6 christos
9377 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9378 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9379 1.1 skrll {
9380 1.6 christos /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
9381 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9382 1.1 skrll = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
9383 1.1 skrll
9384 1.6 christos /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
9385 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9386 1.1 skrll = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
9387 1.1 skrll
9388 1.1 skrll /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
9389 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9390 1.1 skrll = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
9391 1.1 skrll
9392 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
9393 1.1 skrll note);
9394 1.1 skrll }
9395 1.1 skrll
9396 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9397 1.6 christos elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9398 1.1 skrll {
9399 1.1 skrll int lwp;
9400 1.1 skrll
9401 1.1 skrll if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
9402 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
9403 1.1 skrll
9404 1.1 skrll if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
9405 1.1 skrll {
9406 1.1 skrll /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
9407 1.1 skrll find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
9408 1.1 skrll since the kernel writes this note out first when it
9409 1.1 skrll creates a core file. */
9410 1.1 skrll
9411 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
9412 1.1 skrll }
9413 1.1 skrll
9414 1.1 skrll /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
9415 1.1 skrll defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
9416 1.1 skrll than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
9417 1.1 skrll understand it. */
9418 1.1 skrll
9419 1.1 skrll if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
9420 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9421 1.1 skrll
9422 1.1 skrll
9423 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
9424 1.1 skrll {
9425 1.1 skrll /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
9426 1.1 skrll PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
9427 1.1 skrll
9428 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_alpha:
9429 1.1 skrll case bfd_arch_sparc:
9430 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
9431 1.1 skrll {
9432 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
9433 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
9434 1.1 skrll
9435 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
9436 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9437 1.4 uwe
9438 1.4 uwe default:
9439 1.4 uwe return TRUE;
9440 1.4 uwe }
9441 1.4 uwe
9442 1.4 uwe /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
9443 1.4 uwe There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
9444 1.4 uwe structure which lacks GBR. */
9445 1.4 uwe
9446 1.4 uwe case bfd_arch_sh:
9447 1.4 uwe switch (note->type)
9448 1.4 uwe {
9449 1.4 uwe case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
9450 1.4 uwe return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
9451 1.4 uwe
9452 1.4 uwe case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+5:
9453 1.4 uwe return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9454 1.1 skrll
9455 1.1 skrll default:
9456 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9457 1.1 skrll }
9458 1.1 skrll
9459 1.1 skrll /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
9460 1.1 skrll PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
9461 1.1 skrll
9462 1.1 skrll default:
9463 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
9464 1.1 skrll {
9465 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
9466 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
9467 1.1 skrll
9468 1.1 skrll case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
9469 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9470 1.1 skrll
9471 1.1 skrll default:
9472 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9473 1.1 skrll }
9474 1.3 christos }
9475 1.3 christos /* NOTREACHED */
9476 1.3 christos }
9477 1.6 christos
9478 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9479 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9480 1.3 christos {
9481 1.6 christos /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
9482 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9483 1.3 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
9484 1.3 christos
9485 1.6 christos /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
9486 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9487 1.3 christos = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
9488 1.3 christos
9489 1.3 christos /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
9490 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9491 1.3 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
9492 1.3 christos
9493 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9494 1.3 christos }
9495 1.3 christos
9496 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
9497 1.3 christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9498 1.3 christos {
9499 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
9500 1.3 christos return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
9501 1.3 christos
9502 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
9503 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
9504 1.3 christos
9505 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
9506 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9507 1.3 christos
9508 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
9509 1.3 christos return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9510 1.3 christos
9511 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
9512 1.3 christos {
9513 1.3 christos asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9514 1.3 christos SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9515 1.3 christos
9516 1.3 christos if (sect == NULL)
9517 1.3 christos return FALSE;
9518 1.3 christos sect->size = note->descsz;
9519 1.3 christos sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9520 1.3 christos sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9521 1.3 christos
9522 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9523 1.3 christos }
9524 1.3 christos
9525 1.3 christos if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
9526 1.3 christos {
9527 1.3 christos asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
9528 1.3 christos SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9529 1.3 christos
9530 1.3 christos if (sect == NULL)
9531 1.3 christos return FALSE;
9532 1.3 christos sect->size = note->descsz;
9533 1.3 christos sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9534 1.3 christos sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9535 1.3 christos
9536 1.3 christos return TRUE;
9537 1.3 christos }
9538 1.1 skrll
9539 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9540 1.1 skrll }
9541 1.1 skrll
9542 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9543 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
9544 1.1 skrll {
9545 1.1 skrll void *ddata = note->descdata;
9546 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
9547 1.1 skrll char *name;
9548 1.6 christos asection *sect;
9549 1.1 skrll short sig;
9550 1.1 skrll unsigned flags;
9551 1.1 skrll
9552 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
9553 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
9554 1.1 skrll
9555 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
9556 1.1 skrll *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
9557 1.1 skrll
9558 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
9559 1.6 christos flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
9560 1.6 christos
9561 1.1 skrll /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
9562 1.1 skrll if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
9563 1.1 skrll {
9564 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
9565 1.1 skrll elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
9566 1.1 skrll }
9567 1.6 christos
9568 1.1 skrll /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
9569 1.1 skrll do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
9570 1.1 skrll thread just in case. */
9571 1.1 skrll if (flags & 0x00000080)
9572 1.3 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
9573 1.1 skrll
9574 1.1 skrll /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
9575 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
9576 1.1 skrll
9577 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
9578 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9579 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9580 1.1 skrll strcpy (name, buf);
9581 1.1 skrll
9582 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9583 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9584 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9585 1.1 skrll
9586 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
9587 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9588 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9589 1.1 skrll
9590 1.1 skrll return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
9591 1.1 skrll }
9592 1.1 skrll
9593 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9594 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
9595 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9596 1.1 skrll long tid,
9597 1.1 skrll char *base)
9598 1.1 skrll {
9599 1.1 skrll char buf[100];
9600 1.1 skrll char *name;
9601 1.3 christos asection *sect;
9602 1.1 skrll
9603 1.1 skrll /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
9604 1.1 skrll sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
9605 1.1 skrll
9606 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
9607 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9608 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9609 1.1 skrll strcpy (name, buf);
9610 1.1 skrll
9611 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9612 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9613 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9614 1.1 skrll
9615 1.6 christos sect->size = note->descsz;
9616 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9617 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 2;
9618 1.1 skrll
9619 1.1 skrll /* This is the current thread. */
9620 1.1 skrll if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
9621 1.1 skrll return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
9622 1.1 skrll
9623 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9624 1.1 skrll }
9625 1.1 skrll
9626 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
9627 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
9628 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
9629 1.1 skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
9630 1.1 skrll
9631 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9632 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9633 1.1 skrll {
9634 1.1 skrll /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
9635 1.1 skrll tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
9636 1.1 skrll function. */
9637 1.1 skrll static long tid = 1;
9638 1.1 skrll
9639 1.1 skrll switch (note->type)
9640 1.1 skrll {
9641 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
9642 1.1 skrll return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
9643 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
9644 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
9645 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
9646 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
9647 1.1 skrll case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
9648 1.1 skrll return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
9649 1.1 skrll default:
9650 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9651 1.1 skrll }
9652 1.1 skrll }
9653 1.1 skrll
9654 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
9655 1.1 skrll elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9656 1.1 skrll {
9657 1.1 skrll char *name;
9658 1.3 christos asection *sect;
9659 1.1 skrll size_t len;
9660 1.1 skrll
9661 1.1 skrll /* Use note name as section name. */
9662 1.1 skrll len = note->namesz;
9663 1.1 skrll name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9664 1.1 skrll if (name == NULL)
9665 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9666 1.1 skrll memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
9667 1.1 skrll name[len - 1] = '\0';
9668 1.1 skrll
9669 1.1 skrll sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9670 1.1 skrll if (sect == NULL)
9671 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
9672 1.1 skrll
9673 1.1 skrll sect->size = note->descsz;
9674 1.1 skrll sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9675 1.1 skrll sect->alignment_power = 1;
9676 1.1 skrll
9677 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
9678 1.1 skrll }
9679 1.1 skrll
9680 1.1 skrll /* Function: elfcore_write_note
9681 1.1 skrll
9682 1.1 skrll Inputs:
9683 1.1 skrll buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
9684 1.1 skrll name of note
9685 1.1 skrll type of note
9686 1.1 skrll data for note
9687 1.1 skrll size of data for note
9688 1.1 skrll
9689 1.1 skrll Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
9690 1.1 skrll for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
9691 1.1 skrll that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
9692 1.1 skrll 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
9693 1.1 skrll
9694 1.1 skrll Return:
9695 1.1 skrll Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
9696 1.1 skrll
9697 1.1 skrll char *
9698 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
9699 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9700 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9701 1.1 skrll const char *name,
9702 1.1 skrll int type,
9703 1.1 skrll const void *input,
9704 1.1 skrll int size)
9705 1.1 skrll {
9706 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Note *xnp;
9707 1.1 skrll size_t namesz;
9708 1.1 skrll size_t newspace;
9709 1.1 skrll char *dest;
9710 1.1 skrll
9711 1.1 skrll namesz = 0;
9712 1.3 christos if (name != NULL)
9713 1.1 skrll namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
9714 1.1 skrll
9715 1.1 skrll newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
9716 1.1 skrll
9717 1.1 skrll buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
9718 1.1 skrll if (buf == NULL)
9719 1.1 skrll return buf;
9720 1.1 skrll dest = buf + *bufsiz;
9721 1.1 skrll *bufsiz += newspace;
9722 1.1 skrll xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
9723 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
9724 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
9725 1.1 skrll H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
9726 1.1 skrll dest = xnp->name;
9727 1.1 skrll if (name != NULL)
9728 1.1 skrll {
9729 1.1 skrll memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
9730 1.1 skrll dest += namesz;
9731 1.1 skrll while (namesz & 3)
9732 1.1 skrll {
9733 1.1 skrll *dest++ = '\0';
9734 1.1 skrll ++namesz;
9735 1.1 skrll }
9736 1.1 skrll }
9737 1.1 skrll memcpy (dest, input, size);
9738 1.1 skrll dest += size;
9739 1.1 skrll while (size & 3)
9740 1.1 skrll {
9741 1.1 skrll *dest++ = '\0';
9742 1.1 skrll ++size;
9743 1.1 skrll }
9744 1.1 skrll return buf;
9745 1.1 skrll }
9746 1.1 skrll
9747 1.1 skrll char *
9748 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
9749 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9750 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9751 1.1 skrll const char *fname,
9752 1.1 skrll const char *psargs)
9753 1.1 skrll {
9754 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9755 1.1 skrll
9756 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
9757 1.1 skrll {
9758 1.1 skrll char *ret;
9759 1.1 skrll ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9760 1.5 christos NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
9761 1.1 skrll if (ret != NULL)
9762 1.1 skrll return ret;
9763 1.1 skrll }
9764 1.1 skrll
9765 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9766 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9767 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9768 1.1 skrll {
9769 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9770 1.1 skrll psinfo32_t data;
9771 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
9772 1.1 skrll #else
9773 1.1 skrll prpsinfo32_t data;
9774 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
9775 1.1 skrll #endif
9776 1.5 christos
9777 1.1 skrll memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9778 1.1 skrll strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
9779 1.1 skrll strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
9780 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9781 1.1 skrll "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
9782 1.1 skrll }
9783 1.1 skrll else
9784 1.1 skrll #endif
9785 1.1 skrll {
9786 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9787 1.1 skrll psinfo_t data;
9788 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
9789 1.1 skrll #else
9790 1.1 skrll prpsinfo_t data;
9791 1.1 skrll int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
9792 1.1 skrll #endif
9793 1.5 christos
9794 1.1 skrll memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9795 1.5 christos strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
9796 1.5 christos strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
9797 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9798 1.5 christos "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
9799 1.1 skrll }
9800 1.1 skrll #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
9801 1.1 skrll
9802 1.6 christos free (buf);
9803 1.6 christos return NULL;
9804 1.6 christos }
9805 1.6 christos
9806 1.6 christos char *
9807 1.6 christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
9808 1.6 christos (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9809 1.6 christos const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
9810 1.6 christos {
9811 1.6 christos struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32 data;
9812 1.6 christos
9813 1.6 christos memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9814 1.6 christos LINUX_PRPSINFO32_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
9815 1.6 christos
9816 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
9817 1.6 christos &data, sizeof (data));
9818 1.6 christos }
9819 1.6 christos
9820 1.6 christos char *
9821 1.6 christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
9822 1.6 christos (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9823 1.6 christos const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
9824 1.6 christos {
9825 1.6 christos struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64 data;
9826 1.6 christos
9827 1.6 christos memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
9828 1.6 christos LINUX_PRPSINFO64_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
9829 1.6 christos
9830 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9831 1.1 skrll "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
9832 1.1 skrll }
9833 1.1 skrll
9834 1.1 skrll char *
9835 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
9836 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9837 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9838 1.1 skrll long pid,
9839 1.1 skrll int cursig,
9840 1.1 skrll const void *gregs)
9841 1.1 skrll {
9842 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9843 1.1 skrll
9844 1.1 skrll if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
9845 1.1 skrll {
9846 1.1 skrll char *ret;
9847 1.1 skrll ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9848 1.1 skrll NT_PRSTATUS,
9849 1.5 christos pid, cursig, gregs);
9850 1.1 skrll if (ret != NULL)
9851 1.1 skrll return ret;
9852 1.1 skrll }
9853 1.1 skrll
9854 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9855 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9856 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9857 1.1 skrll {
9858 1.1 skrll prstatus32_t prstat;
9859 1.5 christos
9860 1.1 skrll memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
9861 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_pid = pid;
9862 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9863 1.1 skrll memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
9864 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
9865 1.1 skrll NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
9866 1.1 skrll }
9867 1.1 skrll else
9868 1.1 skrll #endif
9869 1.1 skrll {
9870 1.1 skrll prstatus_t prstat;
9871 1.5 christos
9872 1.1 skrll memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
9873 1.1 skrll prstat.pr_pid = pid;
9874 1.5 christos prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9875 1.5 christos memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
9876 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
9877 1.5 christos NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
9878 1.1 skrll }
9879 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
9880 1.1 skrll
9881 1.1 skrll free (buf);
9882 1.1 skrll return NULL;
9883 1.1 skrll }
9884 1.1 skrll
9885 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9886 1.1 skrll char *
9887 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
9888 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9889 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9890 1.1 skrll long pid,
9891 1.1 skrll int cursig,
9892 1.1 skrll const void *gregs)
9893 1.1 skrll {
9894 1.1 skrll lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9895 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
9896 1.6 christos
9897 1.1 skrll memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
9898 1.1 skrll lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
9899 1.1 skrll lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
9900 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9901 1.1 skrll memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
9902 1.1 skrll #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9903 1.1 skrll #if !defined(gregs)
9904 1.1 skrll memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
9905 1.1 skrll gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
9906 1.1 skrll #else
9907 1.1 skrll memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
9908 1.1 skrll gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
9909 1.1 skrll #endif
9910 1.1 skrll #endif
9911 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9912 1.1 skrll NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
9913 1.1 skrll }
9914 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
9915 1.1 skrll
9916 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9917 1.1 skrll char *
9918 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
9919 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9920 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9921 1.1 skrll long pid,
9922 1.1 skrll int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9923 1.1 skrll const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9924 1.1 skrll {
9925 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
9926 1.1 skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9927 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9928 1.1 skrll
9929 1.1 skrll if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
9930 1.1 skrll {
9931 1.1 skrll pstatus32_t pstat;
9932 1.1 skrll
9933 1.1 skrll memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9934 1.1 skrll pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9935 1.1 skrll buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9936 1.1 skrll NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9937 1.1 skrll return buf;
9938 1.1 skrll }
9939 1.1 skrll else
9940 1.1 skrll #endif
9941 1.1 skrll {
9942 1.1 skrll pstatus_t pstat;
9943 1.1 skrll
9944 1.1 skrll memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
9945 1.1 skrll pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
9946 1.1 skrll buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
9947 1.1 skrll NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
9948 1.1 skrll return buf;
9949 1.1 skrll }
9950 1.1 skrll }
9951 1.1 skrll #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
9952 1.1 skrll
9953 1.1 skrll char *
9954 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9955 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9956 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9957 1.1 skrll const void *fpregs,
9958 1.1 skrll int size)
9959 1.1 skrll {
9960 1.1 skrll const char *note_name = "CORE";
9961 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9962 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
9963 1.1 skrll }
9964 1.1 skrll
9965 1.1 skrll char *
9966 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
9967 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9968 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9969 1.1 skrll const void *xfpregs,
9970 1.1 skrll int size)
9971 1.1 skrll {
9972 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
9973 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9974 1.3 christos note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
9975 1.3 christos }
9976 1.6 christos
9977 1.6 christos char *
9978 1.6 christos elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
9979 1.6 christos const void *xfpregs, int size)
9980 1.6 christos {
9981 1.3 christos char *note_name;
9982 1.3 christos if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
9983 1.3 christos note_name = "FreeBSD";
9984 1.3 christos else
9985 1.3 christos note_name = "LINUX";
9986 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9987 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
9988 1.1 skrll }
9989 1.1 skrll
9990 1.1 skrll char *
9991 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
9992 1.1 skrll char *buf,
9993 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
9994 1.1 skrll const void *ppc_vmx,
9995 1.1 skrll int size)
9996 1.1 skrll {
9997 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
9998 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
9999 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
10000 1.1 skrll }
10001 1.1 skrll
10002 1.1 skrll char *
10003 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
10004 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10005 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10006 1.1 skrll const void *ppc_vsx,
10007 1.1 skrll int size)
10008 1.1 skrll {
10009 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10010 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10011 1.3 christos note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
10012 1.3 christos }
10013 1.3 christos
10014 1.3 christos static char *
10015 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
10016 1.3 christos char *buf,
10017 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10018 1.3 christos const void *s390_high_gprs,
10019 1.3 christos int size)
10020 1.3 christos {
10021 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10022 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10023 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
10024 1.3 christos s390_high_gprs, size);
10025 1.3 christos }
10026 1.3 christos
10027 1.3 christos char *
10028 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
10029 1.3 christos char *buf,
10030 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10031 1.3 christos const void *s390_timer,
10032 1.3 christos int size)
10033 1.3 christos {
10034 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10035 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10036 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
10037 1.3 christos }
10038 1.3 christos
10039 1.3 christos char *
10040 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
10041 1.3 christos char *buf,
10042 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10043 1.3 christos const void *s390_todcmp,
10044 1.3 christos int size)
10045 1.3 christos {
10046 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10047 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10048 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
10049 1.3 christos }
10050 1.3 christos
10051 1.3 christos char *
10052 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
10053 1.3 christos char *buf,
10054 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10055 1.3 christos const void *s390_todpreg,
10056 1.3 christos int size)
10057 1.3 christos {
10058 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10059 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10060 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
10061 1.3 christos }
10062 1.3 christos
10063 1.3 christos char *
10064 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
10065 1.3 christos char *buf,
10066 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10067 1.3 christos const void *s390_ctrs,
10068 1.3 christos int size)
10069 1.3 christos {
10070 1.3 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10071 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10072 1.3 christos note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
10073 1.3 christos }
10074 1.3 christos
10075 1.3 christos char *
10076 1.3 christos elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
10077 1.3 christos char *buf,
10078 1.3 christos int *bufsiz,
10079 1.3 christos const void *s390_prefix,
10080 1.3 christos int size)
10081 1.3 christos {
10082 1.1 skrll char *note_name = "LINUX";
10083 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10084 1.5 christos note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
10085 1.5 christos }
10086 1.5 christos
10087 1.5 christos char *
10088 1.5 christos elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
10089 1.5 christos char *buf,
10090 1.5 christos int *bufsiz,
10091 1.5 christos const void *s390_last_break,
10092 1.5 christos int size)
10093 1.5 christos {
10094 1.5 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10095 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10096 1.5 christos note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
10097 1.5 christos s390_last_break, size);
10098 1.5 christos }
10099 1.5 christos
10100 1.5 christos char *
10101 1.5 christos elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
10102 1.5 christos char *buf,
10103 1.5 christos int *bufsiz,
10104 1.5 christos const void *s390_system_call,
10105 1.5 christos int size)
10106 1.5 christos {
10107 1.5 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10108 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10109 1.6 christos note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
10110 1.6 christos s390_system_call, size);
10111 1.6 christos }
10112 1.6 christos
10113 1.6 christos char *
10114 1.6 christos elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
10115 1.6 christos char *buf,
10116 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10117 1.6 christos const void *s390_tdb,
10118 1.6 christos int size)
10119 1.6 christos {
10120 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10121 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10122 1.6 christos note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
10123 1.6 christos }
10124 1.6 christos
10125 1.6 christos char *
10126 1.6 christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
10127 1.6 christos char *buf,
10128 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10129 1.6 christos const void *s390_vxrs_low,
10130 1.6 christos int size)
10131 1.6 christos {
10132 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10133 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10134 1.6 christos note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
10135 1.6 christos }
10136 1.6 christos
10137 1.6 christos char *
10138 1.6 christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
10139 1.6 christos char *buf,
10140 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10141 1.6 christos const void *s390_vxrs_high,
10142 1.6 christos int size)
10143 1.6 christos {
10144 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10145 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10146 1.5 christos note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
10147 1.5 christos s390_vxrs_high, size);
10148 1.5 christos }
10149 1.5 christos
10150 1.5 christos char *
10151 1.5 christos elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
10152 1.5 christos char *buf,
10153 1.5 christos int *bufsiz,
10154 1.5 christos const void *arm_vfp,
10155 1.5 christos int size)
10156 1.5 christos {
10157 1.5 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10158 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10159 1.6 christos note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
10160 1.6 christos }
10161 1.6 christos
10162 1.6 christos char *
10163 1.6 christos elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
10164 1.6 christos char *buf,
10165 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10166 1.6 christos const void *aarch_tls,
10167 1.6 christos int size)
10168 1.6 christos {
10169 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10170 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10171 1.6 christos note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
10172 1.6 christos }
10173 1.6 christos
10174 1.6 christos char *
10175 1.6 christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
10176 1.6 christos char *buf,
10177 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10178 1.6 christos const void *aarch_hw_break,
10179 1.6 christos int size)
10180 1.6 christos {
10181 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10182 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10183 1.6 christos note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
10184 1.6 christos }
10185 1.6 christos
10186 1.6 christos char *
10187 1.6 christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
10188 1.6 christos char *buf,
10189 1.6 christos int *bufsiz,
10190 1.6 christos const void *aarch_hw_watch,
10191 1.6 christos int size)
10192 1.6 christos {
10193 1.6 christos char *note_name = "LINUX";
10194 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10195 1.1 skrll note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
10196 1.1 skrll }
10197 1.1 skrll
10198 1.1 skrll char *
10199 1.1 skrll elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
10200 1.1 skrll char *buf,
10201 1.1 skrll int *bufsiz,
10202 1.1 skrll const char *section,
10203 1.1 skrll const void *data,
10204 1.1 skrll int size)
10205 1.3 christos {
10206 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
10207 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10208 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
10209 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10210 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
10211 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10212 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
10213 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10214 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
10215 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10216 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
10217 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10218 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
10219 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10220 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
10221 1.3 christos return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10222 1.3 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
10223 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10224 1.5 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
10225 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10226 1.5 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
10227 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10228 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
10229 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10230 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
10231 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10232 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
10233 1.5 christos return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10234 1.5 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
10235 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10236 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
10237 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10238 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
10239 1.6 christos return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10240 1.6 christos if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
10241 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10242 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
10243 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10244 1.1 skrll if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
10245 1.1 skrll return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10246 1.1 skrll return NULL;
10247 1.1 skrll }
10248 1.1 skrll
10249 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10250 1.1 skrll elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
10251 1.1 skrll {
10252 1.1 skrll char *p;
10253 1.1 skrll
10254 1.1 skrll p = buf;
10255 1.1 skrll while (p < buf + size)
10256 1.1 skrll {
10257 1.1 skrll /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption. */
10258 1.1 skrll Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
10259 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Note in;
10260 1.1 skrll
10261 1.1 skrll if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
10262 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10263 1.1 skrll
10264 1.1 skrll in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
10265 1.1 skrll
10266 1.1 skrll in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
10267 1.1 skrll in.namedata = xnp->name;
10268 1.1 skrll if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
10269 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10270 1.1 skrll
10271 1.1 skrll in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
10272 1.1 skrll in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
10273 1.1 skrll in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
10274 1.1 skrll if (in.descsz != 0
10275 1.1 skrll && (in.descdata >= buf + size
10276 1.1 skrll || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
10277 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10278 1.1 skrll
10279 1.1 skrll switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
10280 1.6 christos {
10281 1.6 christos default:
10282 1.6 christos return TRUE;
10283 1.1 skrll
10284 1.6 christos case bfd_core:
10285 1.6 christos {
10286 1.6 christos #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
10287 1.1 skrll struct
10288 1.6 christos {
10289 1.3 christos const char * string;
10290 1.6 christos size_t len;
10291 1.6 christos bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
10292 1.6 christos }
10293 1.6 christos grokers[] =
10294 1.6 christos {
10295 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
10296 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
10297 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
10298 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
10299 1.6 christos GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
10300 1.6 christos };
10301 1.6 christos #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
10302 1.6 christos int i;
10303 1.6 christos
10304 1.6 christos for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
10305 1.6 christos {
10306 1.6 christos if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
10307 1.6 christos && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
10308 1.6 christos grokers[i].len) == 0)
10309 1.6 christos {
10310 1.6 christos if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
10311 1.6 christos return FALSE;
10312 1.1 skrll break;
10313 1.1 skrll }
10314 1.1 skrll }
10315 1.1 skrll break;
10316 1.1 skrll }
10317 1.1 skrll
10318 1.1 skrll case bfd_object:
10319 1.5 christos if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
10320 1.5 christos {
10321 1.5 christos if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
10322 1.5 christos return FALSE;
10323 1.5 christos }
10324 1.5 christos else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
10325 1.1 skrll && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
10326 1.1 skrll {
10327 1.1 skrll if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
10328 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10329 1.1 skrll }
10330 1.1 skrll break;
10331 1.1 skrll }
10332 1.1 skrll
10333 1.1 skrll p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
10334 1.1 skrll }
10335 1.1 skrll
10336 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10337 1.1 skrll }
10338 1.1 skrll
10339 1.1 skrll static bfd_boolean
10340 1.1 skrll elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
10341 1.1 skrll {
10342 1.1 skrll char *buf;
10343 1.1 skrll
10344 1.1 skrll if (size <= 0)
10345 1.6 christos return TRUE;
10346 1.1 skrll
10347 1.1 skrll if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
10348 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10349 1.6 christos
10350 1.6 christos buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
10351 1.6 christos if (buf == NULL)
10352 1.6 christos return FALSE;
10353 1.1 skrll
10354 1.1 skrll /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
10355 1.1 skrll 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
10356 1.1 skrll buf[size] = 0;
10357 1.1 skrll
10358 1.1 skrll if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
10359 1.1 skrll || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
10360 1.1 skrll {
10361 1.1 skrll free (buf);
10362 1.1 skrll return FALSE;
10363 1.1 skrll }
10364 1.1 skrll
10365 1.1 skrll free (buf);
10366 1.1 skrll return TRUE;
10367 1.1 skrll }
10368 1.1 skrll
10369 1.1 skrll /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
10371 1.1 skrll
10372 1.1 skrll /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
10373 1.1 skrll copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
10374 1.1 skrll occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
10375 1.1 skrll
10376 1.1 skrll long
10377 1.1 skrll bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
10378 1.1 skrll {
10379 1.1 skrll if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10380 1.1 skrll {
10381 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
10382 1.1 skrll return -1;
10383 1.1 skrll }
10384 1.1 skrll
10385 1.1 skrll return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
10386 1.1 skrll }
10387 1.1 skrll
10388 1.1 skrll /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
10389 1.1 skrll will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
10390 1.1 skrll defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
10391 1.1 skrll buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
10392 1.1 skrll
10393 1.1 skrll Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
10394 1.1 skrll error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
10395 1.1 skrll
10396 1.1 skrll int
10397 1.1 skrll bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
10398 1.1 skrll {
10399 1.1 skrll int num_phdrs;
10400 1.1 skrll
10401 1.1 skrll if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10402 1.1 skrll {
10403 1.1 skrll bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
10404 1.1 skrll return -1;
10405 1.1 skrll }
10406 1.1 skrll
10407 1.1 skrll num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
10408 1.1 skrll memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
10409 1.6 christos num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
10410 1.6 christos
10411 1.6 christos return num_phdrs;
10412 1.1 skrll }
10413 1.1 skrll
10414 1.1 skrll enum elf_reloc_type_class
10415 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10416 1.1 skrll const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10417 1.1 skrll const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10418 1.1 skrll {
10419 1.1 skrll return reloc_class_normal;
10420 1.1 skrll }
10421 1.1 skrll
10422 1.1 skrll /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
10423 1.1 skrll relocation against a local symbol. */
10424 1.1 skrll
10425 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
10426 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
10427 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10428 1.1 skrll asection **psec,
10429 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
10430 1.1 skrll {
10431 1.1 skrll asection *sec = *psec;
10432 1.1 skrll bfd_vma relocation;
10433 1.5 christos
10434 1.1 skrll relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
10435 1.1 skrll + sec->output_offset
10436 1.1 skrll + sym->st_value);
10437 1.1 skrll if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
10438 1.1 skrll && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
10439 1.1 skrll && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
10440 1.1 skrll {
10441 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend =
10442 1.1 skrll _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
10443 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
10444 1.1 skrll sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
10445 1.1 skrll if (sec != *psec)
10446 1.1 skrll {
10447 1.1 skrll /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
10448 1.1 skrll marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
10449 1.1 skrll SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
10450 1.1 skrll other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
10451 1.1 skrll some info around for --emit-relocs. */
10452 1.1 skrll if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
10453 1.1 skrll sec->kept_section = *psec;
10454 1.1 skrll sec = *psec;
10455 1.1 skrll }
10456 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend -= relocation;
10457 1.1 skrll rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
10458 1.1 skrll }
10459 1.1 skrll return relocation;
10460 1.1 skrll }
10461 1.1 skrll
10462 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
10463 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
10464 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10465 1.1 skrll asection **psec,
10466 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addend)
10467 1.1 skrll {
10468 1.1 skrll asection *sec = *psec;
10469 1.1 skrll
10470 1.1 skrll if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
10471 1.1 skrll return sym->st_value + addend;
10472 1.1 skrll
10473 1.1 skrll return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
10474 1.1 skrll elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
10475 1.1 skrll sym->st_value + addend);
10476 1.1 skrll }
10477 1.1 skrll
10478 1.1 skrll bfd_vma
10479 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
10480 1.5 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
10481 1.1 skrll asection *sec,
10482 1.1 skrll bfd_vma offset)
10483 1.5 christos {
10484 1.1 skrll switch (sec->sec_info_type)
10485 1.1 skrll {
10486 1.5 christos case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
10487 1.5 christos return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
10488 1.5 christos offset);
10489 1.5 christos case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
10490 1.5 christos return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
10491 1.5 christos default:
10492 1.1 skrll if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
10493 1.1 skrll {
10494 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10495 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
10496 1.1 skrll offset = sec->size - offset - address_size;
10497 1.1 skrll }
10498 1.1 skrll return offset;
10499 1.1 skrll }
10500 1.1 skrll }
10501 1.1 skrll
10502 1.1 skrll /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
10504 1.1 skrll reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
10505 1.1 skrll based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
10506 1.1 skrll points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
10507 1.1 skrll between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
10508 1.1 skrll file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
10509 1.1 skrll
10510 1.1 skrll The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
10511 1.1 skrll remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
10512 1.1 skrll should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
10513 1.6 christos be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
10514 1.1 skrll the remote memory. */
10515 1.5 christos
10516 1.1 skrll bfd *
10517 1.1 skrll bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
10518 1.6 christos (bfd *templ,
10519 1.1 skrll bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
10520 1.1 skrll bfd_size_type size,
10521 1.1 skrll bfd_vma *loadbasep,
10522 1.1 skrll int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
10523 1.1 skrll {
10524 1.1 skrll return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
10525 1.1 skrll (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
10526 1.1 skrll }
10527 1.1 skrll
10528 1.1 skrll long
10530 1.1 skrll _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
10531 1.1 skrll long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10532 1.1 skrll asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10533 1.1 skrll long dynsymcount,
10534 1.1 skrll asymbol **dynsyms,
10535 1.1 skrll asymbol **ret)
10536 1.1 skrll {
10537 1.1 skrll const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10538 1.1 skrll asection *relplt;
10539 1.1 skrll asymbol *s;
10540 1.1 skrll const char *relplt_name;
10541 1.1 skrll bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
10542 1.1 skrll arelent *p;
10543 1.1 skrll long count, i, n;
10544 1.1 skrll size_t size;
10545 1.1 skrll Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
10546 1.1 skrll char *names;
10547 1.1 skrll asection *plt;
10548 1.1 skrll
10549 1.1 skrll *ret = NULL;
10550 1.1 skrll
10551 1.1 skrll if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
10552 1.1 skrll return 0;
10553 1.1 skrll
10554 1.1 skrll if (dynsymcount <= 0)
10555 1.1 skrll return 0;
10556 1.1 skrll
10557 1.1 skrll if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
10558 1.1 skrll return 0;
10559 1.1 skrll
10560 1.1 skrll relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
10561 1.1 skrll if (relplt_name == NULL)
10562 1.1 skrll relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
10563 1.1 skrll relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
10564 1.1 skrll if (relplt == NULL)
10565 1.1 skrll return 0;
10566 1.1 skrll
10567 1.1 skrll hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
10568 1.1 skrll if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
10569 1.1 skrll || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
10570 1.1 skrll return 0;
10571 1.1 skrll
10572 1.1 skrll plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
10573 1.1 skrll if (plt == NULL)
10574 1.1 skrll return 0;
10575 1.1 skrll
10576 1.3 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
10577 1.3 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
10578 1.3 christos return -1;
10579 1.3 christos
10580 1.3 christos count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
10581 1.3 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
10582 1.3 christos p = relplt->relocation;
10583 1.3 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
10584 1.3 christos {
10585 1.3 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
10586 1.3 christos if (p->addend != 0)
10587 1.1 skrll {
10588 1.3 christos #ifdef BFD64
10589 1.1 skrll size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
10590 1.1 skrll #else
10591 1.1 skrll size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
10592 1.1 skrll #endif
10593 1.1 skrll }
10594 1.1 skrll }
10595 1.1 skrll
10596 1.1 skrll s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
10597 1.1 skrll if (s == NULL)
10598 1.1 skrll return -1;
10599 1.1 skrll
10600 1.1 skrll names = (char *) (s + count);
10601 1.1 skrll p = relplt->relocation;
10602 1.1 skrll n = 0;
10603 1.1 skrll for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
10604 1.1 skrll {
10605 1.1 skrll size_t len;
10606 1.1 skrll bfd_vma addr;
10607 1.1 skrll
10608 1.1 skrll addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
10609 1.1 skrll if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
10610 1.1 skrll continue;
10611 1.1 skrll
10612 1.1 skrll *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
10613 1.1 skrll /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
10614 1.1 skrll we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
10615 1.1 skrll if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
10616 1.1 skrll s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
10617 1.3 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
10618 1.3 christos s->section = plt;
10619 1.3 christos s->value = addr - plt->vma;
10620 1.5 christos s->name = names;
10621 1.3 christos s->udata.p = NULL;
10622 1.3 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
10623 1.3 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
10624 1.3 christos names += len;
10625 1.3 christos if (p->addend != 0)
10626 1.3 christos {
10627 1.3 christos char buf[30], *a;
10628 1.3 christos
10629 1.3 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
10630 1.1 skrll names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
10631 1.1 skrll bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
10632 1.1 skrll for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
10633 1.1 skrll ;
10634 1.1 skrll len = strlen (a);
10635 1.1 skrll memcpy (names, a, len);
10636 1.1 skrll names += len;
10637 1.1 skrll }
10638 1.1 skrll memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
10639 1.1 skrll names += sizeof ("@plt");
10640 1.1 skrll ++s, ++n;
10641 1.1 skrll }
10642 1.1 skrll
10643 1.1 skrll return n;
10644 1.6 christos }
10645 1.6 christos
10646 1.1 skrll /* It is only used by x86-64 so far. */
10647 1.1 skrll asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
10648 1.1 skrll = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
10649 1.1 skrll SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
10650 1.1 skrll
10651 1.1 skrll void
10652 1.3 christos _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
10653 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10654 1.5 christos {
10655 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
10656 1.3 christos
10657 1.3 christos i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
10658 1.5 christos
10659 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
10660 1.1 skrll
10661 1.1 skrll /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
10662 1.1 skrll osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
10663 1.1 skrll the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
10664 1.3 christos if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
10665 1.1 skrll && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
10666 1.1 skrll i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
10667 1.1 skrll }
10668 1.1 skrll
10669 1.3 christos
10670 1.3 christos /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
10671 1.1 skrll This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
10672 1.5 christos most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
10673 1.5 christos
10674 1.5 christos bfd_boolean
10675 1.5 christos _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
10676 1.5 christos {
10677 1.5 christos return (type == STT_FUNC
10678 1.5 christos || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
10679 1.5 christos }
10680 1.5 christos
10681 1.5 christos /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
10682 1.5 christos function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
10683 1.5 christos otherwise return zero. */
10684 1.5 christos
10685 1.5 christos bfd_size_type
10686 1.5 christos _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
10687 1.5 christos bfd_vma *code_off)
10688 1.5 christos {
10689 1.5 christos bfd_size_type size;
10690 1.5 christos
10691 1.5 christos if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
10692 1.5 christos | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
10693 1.5 christos || sym->section != sec)
10694 1.5 christos return 0;
10695 1.5 christos
10696 *code_off = sym->value;
10697 size = 0;
10698 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
10699 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
10700 if (size == 0)
10701 size = 1;
10702 return size;
10703 }
10704